xref: /linux/include/net/mac80211.h (revision 91a4855d6c03e770e42f17c798a36a3c46e63de2)
1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */
2 /*
3  * mac80211 <-> driver interface
4  *
5  * Copyright 2002-2005, Devicescape Software, Inc.
6  * Copyright 2006-2007	Jiri Benc <jbenc@suse.cz>
7  * Copyright 2007-2010	Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
8  * Copyright 2013-2014  Intel Mobile Communications GmbH
9  * Copyright (C) 2015 - 2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH
10  * Copyright (C) 2018 - 2026 Intel Corporation
11  */
12 
13 #ifndef MAC80211_H
14 #define MAC80211_H
15 
16 #include <linux/bug.h>
17 #include <linux/kernel.h>
18 #include <linux/if_ether.h>
19 #include <linux/skbuff.h>
20 #include <linux/ieee80211.h>
21 #include <linux/lockdep.h>
22 #include <net/cfg80211.h>
23 #include <net/codel.h>
24 #include <net/ieee80211_radiotap.h>
25 #include <linux/unaligned.h>
26 
27 /**
28  * DOC: Introduction
29  *
30  * mac80211 is the Linux stack for 802.11 hardware that implements
31  * only partial functionality in hard- or firmware. This document
32  * defines the interface between mac80211 and low-level hardware
33  * drivers.
34  */
35 
36 /**
37  * DOC: Calling mac80211 from interrupts
38  *
39  * Only ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() can be
40  * called in hardware interrupt context. The low-level driver must not call any
41  * other functions in hardware interrupt context. If there is a need for such
42  * call, the low-level driver should first ACK the interrupt and perform the
43  * IEEE 802.11 code call after this, e.g. from a scheduled workqueue or even
44  * tasklet function.
45  *
46  * NOTE: If the driver opts to use the _irqsafe() functions, it may not also
47  *	 use the non-IRQ-safe functions!
48  */
49 
50 /**
51  * DOC: Warning
52  *
53  * If you're reading this document and not the header file itself, it will
54  * be incomplete because not all documentation has been converted yet.
55  */
56 
57 /**
58  * DOC: Frame format
59  *
60  * As a general rule, when frames are passed between mac80211 and the driver,
61  * they start with the IEEE 802.11 header and include the same octets that are
62  * sent over the air except for the FCS which should be calculated by the
63  * hardware.
64  *
65  * There are, however, various exceptions to this rule for advanced features:
66  *
67  * The first exception is for hardware encryption and decryption offload
68  * where the IV/ICV may or may not be generated in hardware.
69  *
70  * Secondly, when the hardware handles fragmentation, the frame handed to
71  * the driver from mac80211 is the MSDU, not the MPDU.
72  */
73 
74 /**
75  * DOC: mac80211 workqueue
76  *
77  * mac80211 provides its own workqueue for drivers and internal mac80211 use.
78  * The workqueue is a single threaded workqueue and can only be accessed by
79  * helpers for sanity checking. Drivers must ensure all work added onto the
80  * mac80211 workqueue should be cancelled on the driver stop() callback.
81  *
82  * mac80211 will flush the workqueue upon interface removal and during
83  * suspend.
84  *
85  * All work performed on the mac80211 workqueue must not acquire the RTNL lock.
86  *
87  */
88 
89 /**
90  * DOC: mac80211 software tx queueing
91  *
92  * mac80211 uses an intermediate queueing implementation, designed to allow the
93  * driver to keep hardware queues short and to provide some fairness between
94  * different stations/interfaces.
95  *
96  * Drivers must provide the .wake_tx_queue driver operation by either
97  * linking it to ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() or implementing a custom
98  * handler.
99  *
100  * Intermediate queues (struct ieee80211_txq) are kept per-sta per-tid, with
101  * another per-sta for non-data/non-mgmt and bufferable management frames, and
102  * a single per-vif queue for multicast data frames.
103  *
104  * The driver is expected to initialize its private per-queue data for stations
105  * and interfaces in the .add_interface and .sta_add ops.
106  *
107  * The driver can't access the internal TX queues (iTXQs) directly.
108  * Whenever mac80211 adds a new frame to a queue, it calls the .wake_tx_queue
109  * driver op.
110  * Drivers implementing a custom .wake_tx_queue op can get them by calling
111  * ieee80211_tx_dequeue(). Drivers using ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() will
112  * simply get the individual frames pushed via the .tx driver operation.
113  *
114  * Drivers can optionally delegate responsibility for scheduling queues to
115  * mac80211, to take advantage of airtime fairness accounting. In this case, to
116  * obtain the next queue to pull frames from, the driver calls
117  * ieee80211_next_txq(). The driver is then expected to return the txq using
118  * ieee80211_return_txq().
119  *
120  * For AP powersave TIM handling, the driver only needs to indicate if it has
121  * buffered packets in the driver specific data structures by calling
122  * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(). For frames buffered in the ieee80211_txq
123  * struct, mac80211 sets the appropriate TIM PVB bits and calls
124  * .release_buffered_frames().
125  * In that callback the driver is therefore expected to release its own
126  * buffered frames and afterwards also frames from the ieee80211_txq (obtained
127  * via the usual ieee80211_tx_dequeue).
128  */
129 
130 /**
131  * DOC: HW timestamping
132  *
133  * Timing Measurement and Fine Timing Measurement require accurate timestamps
134  * of the action frames TX/RX and their respective acks.
135  *
136  * To report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine Timing
137  * Measurement frame RX, the low level driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp
138  * field to the frame RX timestamp and report the ack TX timestamp in the
139  * ieee80211_rx_status struct.
140  *
141  * Similarly, to report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine
142  * Timing Measurement frame TX, the driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp field
143  * to the frame TX timestamp and report the ack RX timestamp in the
144  * ieee80211_tx_status struct.
145  */
146 struct device;
147 
148 /**
149  * enum ieee80211_max_queues - maximum number of queues
150  *
151  * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES: Maximum number of regular device queues.
152  * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP: bitmap with maximum queues set
153  */
154 enum ieee80211_max_queues {
155 	IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES =		16,
156 	IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP =	BIT(IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES) - 1,
157 };
158 
159 #define IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE	0xff
160 
161 /**
162  * enum ieee80211_ac_numbers - AC numbers as used in mac80211
163  * @IEEE80211_AC_VO: voice
164  * @IEEE80211_AC_VI: video
165  * @IEEE80211_AC_BE: best effort
166  * @IEEE80211_AC_BK: background
167  */
168 enum ieee80211_ac_numbers {
169 	IEEE80211_AC_VO		= 0,
170 	IEEE80211_AC_VI		= 1,
171 	IEEE80211_AC_BE		= 2,
172 	IEEE80211_AC_BK		= 3,
173 };
174 
175 /**
176  * struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params - transmit queue configuration
177  *
178  * The information provided in this structure is required for QoS
179  * transmit queue configuration. Cf. IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.29.
180  *
181  * @aifs: arbitration interframe space [0..255]
182  * @cw_min: minimum contention window [a value of the form
183  *	2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
184  * @cw_max: maximum contention window [like @cw_min]
185  * @txop: maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
186  * @acm: is mandatory admission control required for the access category
187  * @uapsd: is U-APSD mode enabled for the queue
188  * @mu_edca: is the MU EDCA configured
189  * @mu_edca_param_rec: MU EDCA Parameter Record for HE
190  */
191 struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params {
192 	u16 txop;
193 	u16 cw_min;
194 	u16 cw_max;
195 	u8 aifs;
196 	bool acm;
197 	bool uapsd;
198 	bool mu_edca;
199 	struct ieee80211_he_mu_edca_param_ac_rec mu_edca_param_rec;
200 };
201 
202 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats {
203 	unsigned int dot11ACKFailureCount;
204 	unsigned int dot11RTSFailureCount;
205 	unsigned int dot11FCSErrorCount;
206 	unsigned int dot11RTSSuccessCount;
207 };
208 
209 /**
210  * enum ieee80211_chanctx_change - change flag for channel context
211  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH: The channel width changed
212  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS: The number of RX chains changed
213  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR: radar detection flag changed
214  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL: switched to another operating channel,
215  *	this is used only with channel switching with CSA
216  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_DEF: The min chandef changed
217  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_AP: The AP channel definition changed, so (wider
218  *	bandwidth) OFDMA settings need to be changed
219  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_PUNCTURING: The punctured channel(s) bitmap
220  *	was changed.
221  */
222 enum ieee80211_chanctx_change {
223 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH		= BIT(0),
224 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS	= BIT(1),
225 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR		= BIT(2),
226 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL	= BIT(3),
227 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_DEF	= BIT(4),
228 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_AP		= BIT(5),
229 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_PUNCTURING	= BIT(6),
230 };
231 
232 /**
233  * struct ieee80211_chan_req - A channel "request"
234  * @oper: channel definition to use for operation
235  * @ap: the channel definition of the AP, if any
236  *	(otherwise the chan member is %NULL)
237  */
238 struct ieee80211_chan_req {
239 	struct cfg80211_chan_def oper;
240 	struct cfg80211_chan_def ap;
241 };
242 
243 /**
244  * struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf - channel context that vifs may be tuned to
245  *
246  * This is the driver-visible part. The ieee80211_chanctx
247  * that contains it is visible in mac80211 only.
248  *
249  * @def: the channel definition
250  * @min_def: the minimum channel definition currently required.
251  * @ap: the channel definition the AP actually is operating as,
252  *	for use with (wider bandwidth) OFDMA
253  * @radio_idx: index of the wiphy radio used used for this channel
254  * @rx_chains_static: The number of RX chains that must always be
255  *	active on the channel to receive MIMO transmissions
256  * @rx_chains_dynamic: The number of RX chains that must be enabled
257  *	after RTS/CTS handshake to receive SMPS MIMO transmissions;
258  *	this will always be >= @rx_chains_static.
259  * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled on this channel.
260  * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
261  *	sizeof(void *), size is determined in hw information.
262  */
263 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf {
264 	struct cfg80211_chan_def def;
265 	struct cfg80211_chan_def min_def;
266 	struct cfg80211_chan_def ap;
267 
268 	int radio_idx;
269 	u8 rx_chains_static, rx_chains_dynamic;
270 
271 	bool radar_enabled;
272 
273 	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
274 };
275 
276 /**
277  * enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode - channel context switch mode
278  * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF: Both old and new contexts already
279  *	exist (and will continue to exist), but the virtual interface
280  *	needs to be switched from one to the other.
281  * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS: The old context exists but will stop
282  *      to exist with this call, the new context doesn't exist but
283  *      will be active after this call, the virtual interface switches
284  *      from the old to the new (note that the driver may of course
285  *      implement this as an on-the-fly chandef switch of the existing
286  *      hardware context, but the mac80211 pointer for the old context
287  *      will cease to exist and only the new one will later be used
288  *      for changes/removal.)
289  */
290 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode {
291 	CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF,
292 	CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS,
293 };
294 
295 /**
296  * struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch - vif chanctx switch information
297  *
298  * This is structure is used to pass information about a vif that
299  * needs to switch from one chanctx to another.  The
300  * &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode defines how the switch should be
301  * done.
302  *
303  * @vif: the vif that should be switched from old_ctx to new_ctx
304  * @link_conf: the link conf that's switching
305  * @old_ctx: the old context to which the vif was assigned
306  * @new_ctx: the new context to which the vif must be assigned
307  */
308 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch {
309 	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
310 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf;
311 	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *old_ctx;
312 	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *new_ctx;
313 };
314 
315 /**
316  * enum ieee80211_bss_change - BSS change notification flags
317  *
318  * These flags are used with the bss_info_changed(), link_info_changed()
319  * and vif_cfg_changed() callbacks to indicate which parameter(s) changed.
320  *
321  * @BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC: association status changed (associated/disassociated),
322  *	also implies a change in the AID.
323  * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT: CTS protection changed
324  * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE: preamble changed
325  * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT: slot timing changed
326  * @BSS_CHANGED_HT: 802.11n parameters changed
327  * @BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES: Basic rateset changed
328  * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT: Beacon interval changed
329  * @BSS_CHANGED_BSSID: BSSID changed, for whatever
330  *	reason (IBSS and managed mode)
331  * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON: Beacon data changed, retrieve
332  *	new beacon (beaconing modes)
333  * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED: Beaconing should be
334  *	enabled/disabled (beaconing modes)
335  * @BSS_CHANGED_CQM: Connection quality monitor config changed
336  * @BSS_CHANGED_IBSS: IBSS join status changed
337  * @BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER: Hardware ARP filter address list or state changed.
338  * @BSS_CHANGED_QOS: QoS for this association was enabled/disabled. Note
339  *	that it is only ever disabled for station mode.
340  * @BSS_CHANGED_IDLE: Idle changed for this BSS/interface.
341  * @BSS_CHANGED_SSID: SSID changed for this BSS (AP and IBSS mode)
342  * @BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response changed for this BSS (AP mode)
343  * @BSS_CHANGED_PS: PS changed for this BSS (STA mode)
344  * @BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER: TX power setting changed for this interface
345  * @BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS: P2P powersave settings (CTWindow, opportunistic PS)
346  *	changed
347  * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO: Data from the AP's beacon became available:
348  *	currently dtim_period only is under consideration.
349  * @BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH: The bandwidth used by this interface changed,
350  *	note that this is only called when it changes after the channel
351  *	context had been assigned.
352  * @BSS_CHANGED_OCB: OCB join status changed
353  * @BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS: VHT MU-MIMO group id or user position changed
354  * @BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE: keep alive options (idle period or protected
355  *	keep alive) changed.
356  * @BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE: Multicast Rate setting changed for this interface
357  * @BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER: fine timing measurement request responder
358  *	functionality changed for this BSS (AP mode).
359  * @BSS_CHANGED_TWT: TWT status changed
360  * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD: OBSS Packet Detection status changed.
361  * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR: BSS Color has changed
362  * @BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY: FILS discovery status changed.
363  * @BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
364  *	status changed.
365  * @BSS_CHANGED_MLD_VALID_LINKS: MLD valid links status changed.
366  * @BSS_CHANGED_MLD_TTLM: negotiated TID to link mapping was changed
367  * @BSS_CHANGED_TPE: transmit power envelope changed
368  * @BSS_CHANGED_NAN_LOCAL_SCHED: NAN local schedule changed (NAN mode only)
369  */
370 enum ieee80211_bss_change {
371 	BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC		= 1<<0,
372 	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT	= 1<<1,
373 	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE	= 1<<2,
374 	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT		= 1<<3,
375 	BSS_CHANGED_HT			= 1<<4,
376 	BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES		= 1<<5,
377 	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT		= 1<<6,
378 	BSS_CHANGED_BSSID		= 1<<7,
379 	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON		= 1<<8,
380 	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED	= 1<<9,
381 	BSS_CHANGED_CQM			= 1<<10,
382 	BSS_CHANGED_IBSS		= 1<<11,
383 	BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER		= 1<<12,
384 	BSS_CHANGED_QOS			= 1<<13,
385 	BSS_CHANGED_IDLE		= 1<<14,
386 	BSS_CHANGED_SSID		= 1<<15,
387 	BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP	= 1<<16,
388 	BSS_CHANGED_PS			= 1<<17,
389 	BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER		= 1<<18,
390 	BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS		= 1<<19,
391 	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO		= 1<<20,
392 	BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH		= 1<<21,
393 	BSS_CHANGED_OCB                 = 1<<22,
394 	BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS		= 1<<23,
395 	BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE		= 1<<24,
396 	BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE		= 1<<25,
397 	BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER	= 1<<26,
398 	BSS_CHANGED_TWT			= 1<<27,
399 	BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD		= 1<<28,
400 	BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR	= 1<<29,
401 	BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY      = 1<<30,
402 	BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP = BIT_ULL(31),
403 	BSS_CHANGED_MLD_VALID_LINKS	= BIT_ULL(33),
404 	BSS_CHANGED_MLD_TTLM		= BIT_ULL(34),
405 	BSS_CHANGED_TPE			= BIT_ULL(35),
406 	BSS_CHANGED_NAN_LOCAL_SCHED	= BIT_ULL(36),
407 
408 	/* when adding here, make sure to change ieee80211_reconfig */
409 };
410 
411 /*
412  * The maximum number of IPv4 addresses listed for ARP filtering. If the number
413  * of addresses for an interface increase beyond this value, hardware ARP
414  * filtering will be disabled.
415  */
416 #define IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN 4
417 
418 /**
419  * enum ieee80211_event_type - event to be notified to the low level driver
420  * @RSSI_EVENT: AP's rssi crossed the a threshold set by the driver.
421  * @MLME_EVENT: event related to MLME
422  * @BAR_RX_EVENT: a BAR was received
423  * @BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT: Frames were released from the reordering buffer because
424  *	they timed out. This won't be called for each frame released, but only
425  *	once each time the timeout triggers.
426  */
427 enum ieee80211_event_type {
428 	RSSI_EVENT,
429 	MLME_EVENT,
430 	BAR_RX_EVENT,
431 	BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT,
432 };
433 
434 /**
435  * enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data - relevant when event type is %RSSI_EVENT
436  * @RSSI_EVENT_HIGH: AP's rssi went below the threshold set by the driver.
437  * @RSSI_EVENT_LOW: AP's rssi went above the threshold set by the driver.
438  */
439 enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data {
440 	RSSI_EVENT_HIGH,
441 	RSSI_EVENT_LOW,
442 };
443 
444 /**
445  * struct ieee80211_rssi_event - data attached to an %RSSI_EVENT
446  * @data: See &enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data
447  */
448 struct ieee80211_rssi_event {
449 	enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data data;
450 };
451 
452 /**
453  * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
454  * @AUTH_EVENT: the MLME operation is authentication
455  * @ASSOC_EVENT: the MLME operation is association
456  * @DEAUTH_RX_EVENT: deauth received..
457  * @DEAUTH_TX_EVENT: deauth sent.
458  */
459 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data {
460 	AUTH_EVENT,
461 	ASSOC_EVENT,
462 	DEAUTH_RX_EVENT,
463 	DEAUTH_TX_EVENT,
464 };
465 
466 /**
467  * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
468  * @MLME_SUCCESS: the MLME operation completed successfully.
469  * @MLME_DENIED: the MLME operation was denied by the peer.
470  * @MLME_TIMEOUT: the MLME operation timed out.
471  */
472 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status {
473 	MLME_SUCCESS,
474 	MLME_DENIED,
475 	MLME_TIMEOUT,
476 };
477 
478 /**
479  * struct ieee80211_mlme_event - data attached to an %MLME_EVENT
480  * @data: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data
481  * @status: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status
482  * @reason: the reason code if applicable
483  */
484 struct ieee80211_mlme_event {
485 	enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data data;
486 	enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status status;
487 	u16 reason;
488 };
489 
490 /**
491  * struct ieee80211_ba_event - data attached for BlockAck related events
492  * @sta: pointer to the &ieee80211_sta to which this event relates
493  * @tid: the tid
494  * @ssn: the starting sequence number (for %BAR_RX_EVENT)
495  */
496 struct ieee80211_ba_event {
497 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
498 	u16 tid;
499 	u16 ssn;
500 };
501 
502 /**
503  * struct ieee80211_event - event to be sent to the driver
504  * @type: The event itself. See &enum ieee80211_event_type.
505  * @u.rssi: relevant if &type is %RSSI_EVENT
506  * @u.mlme: relevant if &type is %AUTH_EVENT
507  * @u.ba: relevant if &type is %BAR_RX_EVENT or %BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT
508  * @u:union holding the fields above
509  */
510 struct ieee80211_event {
511 	enum ieee80211_event_type type;
512 	union {
513 		struct ieee80211_rssi_event rssi;
514 		struct ieee80211_mlme_event mlme;
515 		struct ieee80211_ba_event ba;
516 	} u;
517 };
518 
519 /**
520  * struct ieee80211_mu_group_data - STA's VHT MU-MIMO group data
521  *
522  * This structure describes the group id data of VHT MU-MIMO
523  *
524  * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
525  * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
526  */
527 struct ieee80211_mu_group_data {
528 	u8 membership[WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN];
529 	u8 position[WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN];
530 };
531 
532 /**
533  * struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params - FTM responder parameters
534  *
535  * @lci: LCI subelement content
536  * @civicloc: CIVIC location subelement content
537  * @lci_len: LCI data length
538  * @civicloc_len: Civic data length
539  */
540 struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params {
541 	const u8 *lci;
542 	const u8 *civicloc;
543 	size_t lci_len;
544 	size_t civicloc_len;
545 };
546 
547 /**
548  * struct ieee80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from
549  * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
550  *
551  * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
552  * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
553  */
554 struct ieee80211_fils_discovery {
555 	u32 min_interval;
556 	u32 max_interval;
557 };
558 
559 #define IEEE80211_TPE_EIRP_ENTRIES_320MHZ	5
560 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe_eirp {
561 	bool valid;
562 	s8 power[IEEE80211_TPE_EIRP_ENTRIES_320MHZ];
563 	u8 count;
564 };
565 
566 #define IEEE80211_TPE_PSD_ENTRIES_320MHZ	16
567 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe_psd {
568 	bool valid;
569 	s8 power[IEEE80211_TPE_PSD_ENTRIES_320MHZ];
570 	u8 count, n;
571 };
572 
573 /**
574  * struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe - parsed transmit power envelope information
575  * @max_local: maximum local EIRP, one value for 20, 40, 80, 160, 320 MHz each
576  *	(indexed by TX power category)
577  * @max_reg_client: maximum regulatory client EIRP, one value for 20, 40, 80,
578  *	160, 320 MHz each
579  *	(indexed by TX power category)
580  * @psd_local: maximum local power spectral density, one value for each 20 MHz
581  *	subchannel per bss_conf's chanreq.oper
582  *	(indexed by TX power category)
583  * @psd_reg_client: maximum regulatory power spectral density, one value for
584  *	each 20 MHz subchannel per bss_conf's chanreq.oper
585  *	(indexed by TX power category)
586  */
587 struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe {
588 	struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe_eirp max_local[2], max_reg_client[2];
589 	struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe_psd psd_local[2], psd_reg_client[2];
590 };
591 
592 /**
593  * struct ieee80211_bss_conf - holds the BSS's changing parameters
594  *
595  * This structure keeps information about a BSS (and an association
596  * to that BSS) that can change during the lifetime of the BSS.
597  *
598  * @vif: reference to owning VIF
599  * @bss: the cfg80211 bss descriptor. Valid only for a station, and only
600  *	when associated. Note: This contains information which is not
601  *	necessarily authenticated. For example, information coming from probe
602  *	responses.
603  * @addr: (link) address used locally
604  * @link_id: link ID, or 0 for non-MLO
605  * @htc_trig_based_pkt_ext: default PE in 4us units, if BSS supports HE
606  * @uora_exists: is the UORA element advertised by AP
607  * @uora_ocw_range: UORA element's OCW Range field
608  * @frame_time_rts_th: HE duration RTS threshold, in units of 32us
609  * @he_support: does this BSS support HE
610  * @twt_requester: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
611  *	mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
612  * @twt_responder: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
613  *	mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
614  * @twt_protected: does this BSS support protected TWT frames
615  * @twt_broadcast: does this BSS support broadcast TWT
616  * @use_cts_prot: use CTS protection
617  * @use_short_preamble: use 802.11b short preamble
618  * @use_short_slot: use short slot time (only relevant for ERP)
619  * @dtim_period: num of beacons before the next DTIM, for beaconing,
620  *	valid in station mode only if after the driver was notified
621  *	with the %BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO flag, will be non-zero then.
622  * @sync_tsf: last beacon's/probe response's TSF timestamp (could be old
623  *	as it may have been received during scanning long ago). If the
624  *	HW flag %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY is set, then this can
625  *	only come from a beacon, but might not become valid until after
626  *	association when a beacon is received (which is notified with the
627  *	%BSS_CHANGED_DTIM flag.). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
628  * @sync_device_ts: the device timestamp corresponding to the sync_tsf,
629  *	the driver/device can use this to calculate synchronisation
630  *	(see @sync_tsf). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
631  * @sync_dtim_count: Only valid when %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY
632  *	is requested, see @sync_tsf/@sync_device_ts.
633  *	IMPORTANT: These three sync_* parameters would possibly be out of sync
634  *	by the time the driver will use them. The synchronized view is currently
635  *	guaranteed only in certain callbacks.
636  *	Note also that this is not used with MLD associations, mac80211 doesn't
637  *	know how to track beacons for all of the links for this.
638  * @beacon_int: beacon interval
639  * @assoc_capability: capabilities taken from assoc resp
640  * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates, each bit stands for an
641  *	index into the rate table configured by the driver in
642  *	the current band.
643  * @beacon_rate: associated AP's beacon TX rate
644  * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
645  * @bssid: The BSSID for this BSS
646  * @enable_beacon: whether beaconing should be enabled or not
647  * @chanreq: Channel request for this BSS -- the hardware might be
648  *	configured a higher bandwidth than this BSS uses, for example.
649  * @mu_group: VHT MU-MIMO group membership data
650  * @ht_operation_mode: HT operation mode like in &struct ieee80211_ht_operation.
651  *	This field is only valid when the channel is a wide HT/VHT channel.
652  *	Note that with TDLS this can be the case (channel is HT, protection must
653  *	be used from this field) even when the BSS association isn't using HT.
654  * @cqm_rssi_thold: Connection quality monitor RSSI threshold, a zero value
655  *	implies disabled. As with the cfg80211 callback, a change here should
656  *	cause an event to be sent indicating where the current value is in
657  *	relation to the newly configured threshold.
658  * @cqm_rssi_low: Connection quality monitor RSSI lower threshold, a zero value
659  *	implies disabled.  This is an alternative mechanism to the single
660  *	threshold event and can't be enabled simultaneously with it.
661  * @cqm_rssi_high: Connection quality monitor RSSI upper threshold.
662  * @cqm_rssi_hyst: Connection quality monitor RSSI hysteresis
663  * @qos: This is a QoS-enabled BSS.
664  * @hidden_ssid: The SSID of the current vif is hidden. Only valid in AP-mode.
665  * @txpower: TX power in dBm.  INT_MIN means not configured.
666  * @txpower_type: TX power adjustment used to control per packet Transmit
667  *	Power Control (TPC) in lower driver for the current vif. In particular
668  *	TPC is enabled if value passed in %txpower_type is
669  *	NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED (allow using less than specified from
670  *	userspace), whereas TPC is disabled if %txpower_type is set to
671  *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED (use value configured from userspace)
672  * @p2p_noa_attr: P2P NoA attribute for P2P powersave
673  * @allow_p2p_go_ps: indication for AP or P2P GO interface, whether it's allowed
674  *	to use P2P PS mechanism or not. AP/P2P GO is not allowed to use P2P PS
675  *	if it has associated clients without P2P PS support.
676  * @max_idle_period: the time period during which the station can refrain from
677  *	transmitting frames to its associated AP without being disassociated.
678  *	In units of 1000 TUs. Zero value indicates that the AP did not include
679  *	a (valid) BSS Max Idle Period Element.
680  * @protected_keep_alive: if set, indicates that the station should send an RSN
681  *	protected frame to the AP to reset the idle timer at the AP for the
682  *	station.
683  * @ftm_responder: whether to enable or disable fine timing measurement FTM
684  *	responder functionality.
685  * @ftmr_params: configurable lci/civic parameter when enabling FTM responder.
686  * @nontransmitted: this BSS is a nontransmitted BSS profile
687  * @tx_bss_conf: Pointer to the BSS configuration of transmitting interface
688  *	if MBSSID is enabled. This pointer is RCU-protected due to CSA finish
689  *	and BSS color change flows accessing it.
690  * @transmitter_bssid: the address of transmitter AP
691  * @bssid_index: index inside the multiple BSSID set
692  * @bssid_indicator: 2^bssid_indicator is the maximum number of APs in set
693  * @ema_ap: AP supports enhancements of discovery and advertisement of
694  *	nontransmitted BSSIDs
695  * @profile_periodicity: the least number of beacon frames need to be received
696  *	in order to discover all the nontransmitted BSSIDs in the set.
697  * @he_oper: HE operation information of the BSS (AP/Mesh) or of the AP we are
698  *	connected to (STA)
699  * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection parameters.
700  * @he_bss_color: BSS coloring settings, if BSS supports HE
701  * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery configuration
702  * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
703  *	interval.
704  * @beacon_tx_rate: The configured beacon transmit rate that needs to be passed
705  *	to driver when rate control is offloaded to firmware.
706  * @power_type: power type of BSS for 6 GHz
707  * @tpe: transmit power envelope information
708  * @pwr_reduction: power constraint of BSS.
709  * @eht_support: does this BSS support EHT
710  * @epcs_support: does this BSS support EPCS
711  * @uhr_support: does this BSS support UHR
712  * @csa_active: marks whether a channel switch is going on.
713  * @mu_mimo_owner: indicates interface owns MU-MIMO capability
714  * @chanctx_conf: The channel context this interface is assigned to, or %NULL
715  *	when it is not assigned. This pointer is RCU-protected due to the TX
716  *	path needing to access it; even though the netdev carrier will always
717  *	be off when it is %NULL there can still be races and packets could be
718  *	processed after it switches back to %NULL.
719  * @color_change_active: marks whether a color change is ongoing.
720  * @color_change_color: the bss color that will be used after the change.
721  * @ht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HT LDPC capability.
722  * @vht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has VHT LDPC capability.
723  * @he_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HE LDPC capability.
724  * @vht_su_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU
725  *	beamformer
726  * @vht_su_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU
727  *	beamformee
728  * @vht_mu_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU
729  *	beamformer
730  * @vht_mu_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU
731  *	beamformee
732  * @he_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU
733  *	beamformer
734  * @he_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU
735  *	beamformee
736  * @he_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE MU
737  *	beamformer
738  * @he_full_ul_mumimo: does this BSS support the reception (AP) or transmission
739  *	(non-AP STA) of an HE TB PPDU on an RU that spans the entire PPDU
740  *	bandwidth
741  * @eht_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU
742  *	beamformer
743  * @eht_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU
744  *	beamformee
745  * @eht_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT MU
746  *	beamformer
747  * @eht_80mhz_full_bw_ul_mumimo: in AP-mode, does this BSS support the
748  *	reception of an EHT TB PPDU on an RU that spans the entire PPDU
749  *	bandwidth
750  * @eht_disable_mcs15: disable EHT-MCS 15 reception capability.
751  * @bss_param_ch_cnt: in BSS-mode, the BSS params change count. This
752  *	information is the latest known value. It can come from this link's
753  *	beacon or from a beacon sent by another link.
754  * @bss_param_ch_cnt_link_id: in BSS-mode, the link_id to which the beacon
755  *	that updated &bss_param_ch_cnt belongs. E.g. if link 1 doesn't hear
756  *	its beacons, and link 2 sent a beacon with an RNR element that updated
757  *	link 1's BSS params change count, then, link 1's
758  *	bss_param_ch_cnt_link_id will be 2. That means that link 1 knows that
759  *	link 2 was the link that updated its bss_param_ch_cnt value.
760  *	In case link 1 hears its beacon again, bss_param_ch_cnt_link_id will
761  *	be updated to 1, even if bss_param_ch_cnt didn't change. This allows
762  *	the link to know that it heard the latest value from its own beacon
763  *	(as opposed to hearing its value from another link's beacon).
764  * @s1g_long_beacon_period: number of beacon intervals between each long
765  *	beacon transmission.
766  */
767 struct ieee80211_bss_conf {
768 	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
769 	struct cfg80211_bss *bss;
770 
771 	const u8 *bssid;
772 	unsigned int link_id;
773 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
774 	u8 htc_trig_based_pkt_ext;
775 	bool uora_exists;
776 	u8 uora_ocw_range;
777 	u16 frame_time_rts_th;
778 	bool he_support;
779 	bool twt_requester;
780 	bool twt_responder;
781 	bool twt_protected;
782 	bool twt_broadcast;
783 	/* erp related data */
784 	bool use_cts_prot;
785 	bool use_short_preamble;
786 	bool use_short_slot;
787 	bool enable_beacon;
788 	u8 dtim_period;
789 	u16 beacon_int;
790 	u16 assoc_capability;
791 	u64 sync_tsf;
792 	u32 sync_device_ts;
793 	u8 sync_dtim_count;
794 	u32 basic_rates;
795 	struct ieee80211_rate *beacon_rate;
796 	int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
797 	u16 ht_operation_mode;
798 	s32 cqm_rssi_thold;
799 	u32 cqm_rssi_hyst;
800 	s32 cqm_rssi_low;
801 	s32 cqm_rssi_high;
802 	struct ieee80211_chan_req chanreq;
803 	struct ieee80211_mu_group_data mu_group;
804 	bool qos;
805 	bool hidden_ssid;
806 	int txpower;
807 	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting txpower_type;
808 	struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr p2p_noa_attr;
809 	bool allow_p2p_go_ps;
810 	u16 max_idle_period;
811 	bool protected_keep_alive;
812 	bool ftm_responder;
813 	struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params *ftmr_params;
814 	/* Multiple BSSID data */
815 	bool nontransmitted;
816 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf __rcu *tx_bss_conf;
817 	u8 transmitter_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
818 	u8 bssid_index;
819 	u8 bssid_indicator;
820 	bool ema_ap;
821 	u8 profile_periodicity;
822 	struct {
823 		u32 params;
824 		u16 nss_set;
825 	} he_oper;
826 	struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd;
827 	struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color;
828 	struct ieee80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
829 	u32 unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval;
830 	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_tx_rate;
831 	enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power power_type;
832 
833 	struct ieee80211_parsed_tpe tpe;
834 
835 	u8 pwr_reduction;
836 	bool eht_support;
837 	bool epcs_support;
838 	bool uhr_support;
839 
840 	bool csa_active;
841 
842 	bool mu_mimo_owner;
843 	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf __rcu *chanctx_conf;
844 
845 	bool color_change_active;
846 	u8 color_change_color;
847 
848 	bool ht_ldpc;
849 	bool vht_ldpc;
850 	bool he_ldpc;
851 	bool vht_su_beamformer;
852 	bool vht_su_beamformee;
853 	bool vht_mu_beamformer;
854 	bool vht_mu_beamformee;
855 	bool he_su_beamformer;
856 	bool he_su_beamformee;
857 	bool he_mu_beamformer;
858 	bool he_full_ul_mumimo;
859 	bool eht_su_beamformer;
860 	bool eht_su_beamformee;
861 	bool eht_mu_beamformer;
862 	bool eht_80mhz_full_bw_ul_mumimo;
863 	bool eht_disable_mcs15;
864 
865 	u8 bss_param_ch_cnt;
866 	u8 bss_param_ch_cnt_link_id;
867 
868 	u8 s1g_long_beacon_period;
869 };
870 
871 #define IEEE80211_NAN_MAX_CHANNELS 3
872 
873 /**
874  * struct ieee80211_nan_channel - NAN channel information
875  *
876  * @chanreq: channel request for this NAN channel. Even though this chanreq::ap
877  *	is irrelevant for NAN, still store it for convenience - some functions
878  *	require it as an argument.
879  * @needed_rx_chains: number of RX chains needed for this NAN channel
880  * @chanctx_conf: chanctx_conf assigned to this NAN channel.
881  *	If a local channel is being ULWed (because we needed this chanctx for
882  *	something else), the local NAN channel that used this chanctx,
883  *	will have this pointer set to %NULL.
884  *	A peer NAN channel should never have this pointer set to %NULL.
885  * @channel_entry: the Channel Entry blob as defined in Wi-Fi Aware
886  *	(TM) 4.0 specification Table 100 (Channel Entry format for the NAN
887  *	Availability attribute).
888  */
889 struct ieee80211_nan_channel {
890 	struct ieee80211_chan_req chanreq;
891 	u8 needed_rx_chains;
892 	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf;
893 	u8 channel_entry[6];
894 };
895 
896 /**
897  * struct ieee80211_nan_peer_map - NAN peer schedule map
898  *
899  * This stores a single map from a peer's schedule. Each peer can have
900  * multiple maps.
901  *
902  * @map_id: the map ID from the peer schedule, %CFG80211_NAN_INVALID_MAP_ID
903  *	if unused
904  * @slots: mapping of time slots to channel configurations in the schedule's
905  *	channels array
906  */
907 struct ieee80211_nan_peer_map {
908 	u8 map_id;
909 	struct ieee80211_nan_channel *slots[CFG80211_NAN_SCHED_NUM_TIME_SLOTS];
910 };
911 
912 /**
913  * struct ieee80211_nan_peer_sched - NAN peer schedule
914  *
915  * This stores the complete schedule from a peer. Contains peer-level
916  * parameters and an array of schedule maps.
917  *
918  * @seq_id: the sequence ID from the peer schedule
919  * @committed_dw: committed DW as published by the peer
920  * @max_chan_switch: maximum channel switch time in microseconds
921  * @init_ulw: initial ULWs as published by the peer (copied)
922  * @ulw_size: number of bytes in @init_ulw
923  * @maps: array of peer schedule maps. Invalid slots have map_id set to
924  *	%CFG80211_NAN_INVALID_MAP_ID.
925  * @n_channels: number of valid channel entries in @channels
926  * @channels: flexible array of negotiated peer channels for this schedule
927  */
928 struct ieee80211_nan_peer_sched {
929 	u8 seq_id;
930 	u16 committed_dw;
931 	u16 max_chan_switch;
932 	const u8 *init_ulw;
933 	u16 ulw_size;
934 	struct ieee80211_nan_peer_map maps[CFG80211_NAN_MAX_PEER_MAPS];
935 	u8 n_channels;
936 	struct ieee80211_nan_channel channels[] __counted_by(n_channels);
937 };
938 
939 /**
940  * enum mac80211_tx_info_flags - flags to describe transmission information/status
941  *
942  * These flags are used with the @flags member of &ieee80211_tx_info.
943  *
944  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS: require TX status callback for this frame.
945  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ: The driver has to assign a sequence
946  *	number to this frame, taking care of not overwriting the fragment
947  *	number and increasing the sequence number only when the
948  *	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT flag is set. mac80211 will properly
949  *	assign sequence numbers to QoS-data frames but cannot do so correctly
950  *	for non-QoS-data and management frames because beacons need them from
951  *	that counter as well and mac80211 cannot guarantee proper sequencing.
952  *	If this flag is set, the driver should instruct the hardware to
953  *	assign a sequence number to the frame or assign one itself. Cf. IEEE
954  *	802.11-2007 7.1.3.4.1 paragraph 3. This flag will always be set for
955  *	beacons and always be clear for frames without a sequence number field.
956  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK: tell the low level not to wait for an ack
957  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT: clear powersave filter for destination
958  *	station
959  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT: this is a first fragment of the frame
960  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM: send this frame after DTIM beacon
961  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU: this frame should be sent as part of an A-MPDU
962  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED: Frame was injected, internal to mac80211.
963  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED: The frame was not transmitted
964  *	because the destination STA was in powersave mode. Note that to
965  *	avoid race conditions, the filter must be set by the hardware or
966  *	firmware upon receiving a frame that indicates that the station
967  *	went to sleep (must be done on device to filter frames already on
968  *	the queue) and may only be unset after mac80211 gives the OK for
969  *	that by setting the IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT (see above),
970  *	since only then is it guaranteed that no more frames are in the
971  *	hardware queue.
972  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK: Frame was acknowledged
973  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU: The frame was aggregated, so status
974  * 	is for the whole aggregation.
975  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK: no block ack was returned,
976  * 	so consider using block ack request (BAR).
977  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE: internal to mac80211, can be
978  *	set by rate control algorithms to indicate probe rate, will
979  *	be cleared for fragmented frames (except on the last fragment)
980  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK: Internal to mac80211. Used to indicate
981  *	that a frame can be transmitted while the queues are stopped for
982  *	off-channel operation.
983  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP: This frame uses hardware encapsulation
984  *	(header conversion)
985  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED: completely internal to mac80211,
986  *	used to indicate that a frame was already retried due to PS
987  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT: completely internal to mac80211,
988  *	used to indicate frame should not be encrypted
989  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER: This frame is a response to a poll
990  *	frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD) or a non-bufferable MMPDU and must
991  *	be sent although the station is in powersave mode.
992  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES: More frames will be passed to the
993  *	transmit function after the current frame, this can be used
994  *	by drivers to kick the DMA queue only if unset or when the
995  *	queue gets full.
996  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION: This frame is being retransmitted
997  *	after TX status because the destination was asleep, it must not
998  *	be modified again (no seqno assignment, crypto, etc.)
999  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX: This frame was transmitted by the MLME
1000  *	code for connection establishment, this indicates that its status
1001  *	should kick the MLME state machine.
1002  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX: Frame was requested through nl80211
1003  *	MLME command (internal to mac80211 to figure out whether to send TX
1004  *	status to user space)
1005  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC: tells the driver to use LDPC for this frame
1006  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC: Enables Space-Time Block Coding (STBC) for this
1007  *	frame and selects the maximum number of streams that it can use.
1008  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN: Marks this packet to be transmitted on
1009  *	the off-channel channel when a remain-on-channel offload is done
1010  *	in hardware -- normal packets still flow and are expected to be
1011  *	handled properly by the device.
1012  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE: Marks this packet to be used for TKIP
1013  *	testing. It will be sent out with incorrect Michael MIC key to allow
1014  *	TKIP countermeasures to be tested.
1015  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE: This frame will be sent at non CCK rate.
1016  *	This flag is actually used for management frame especially for P2P
1017  *	frames not being sent at CCK rate in 2GHz band.
1018  * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP: This packet marks the end of service period,
1019  *	when its status is reported the service period ends. For frames in
1020  *	an SP that mac80211 transmits, it is already set; for driver frames
1021  *	the driver may set this flag. It is also used to do the same for
1022  *	PS-Poll responses.
1023  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE: This frame will be sent at lowest rate.
1024  *	This flag is used to send nullfunc frame at minimum rate when
1025  *	the nullfunc is used for connection monitoring purpose.
1026  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG: Don't fragment this packet even if it
1027  *	would be fragmented by size (this is optional, only used for
1028  *	monitor injection).
1029  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED: A frame that was marked with
1030  *	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK has been successfully transmitted without
1031  *	any errors (like issues specific to the driver/HW).
1032  *	This flag must not be set for frames that don't request no-ack
1033  *	behaviour with IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK.
1034  *
1035  * Note: If you have to add new flags to the enumeration, then don't
1036  *	 forget to update %IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS when necessary.
1037  */
1038 enum mac80211_tx_info_flags {
1039 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS		= BIT(0),
1040 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ		= BIT(1),
1041 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK			= BIT(2),
1042 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT		= BIT(3),
1043 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT		= BIT(4),
1044 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM	= BIT(5),
1045 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU			= BIT(6),
1046 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED		= BIT(7),
1047 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED		= BIT(8),
1048 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK			= BIT(9),
1049 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU			= BIT(10),
1050 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK		= BIT(11),
1051 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE	= BIT(12),
1052 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK	= BIT(13),
1053 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP		= BIT(14),
1054 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED		= BIT(15),
1055 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT		= BIT(16),
1056 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER		= BIT(17),
1057 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES		= BIT(18),
1058 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION	= BIT(19),
1059 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX		= BIT(20),
1060 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX	= BIT(21),
1061 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC			= BIT(22),
1062 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC			= BIT(23) | BIT(24),
1063 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN		= BIT(25),
1064 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE	= BIT(26),
1065 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE		= BIT(27),
1066 	IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP		= BIT(28),
1067 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE		= BIT(29),
1068 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG		= BIT(30),
1069 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED	= BIT(31),
1070 };
1071 
1072 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC_SHIFT		23
1073 
1074 #define IEEE80211_TX_RC_S1G_MCS IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS
1075 
1076 /**
1077  * enum mac80211_tx_control_flags - flags to describe transmit control
1078  *
1079  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO: this frame is a port control
1080  *	protocol frame (e.g. EAP)
1081  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE: This frame is a response to a poll
1082  *	frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD).
1083  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT: This frame is injected with rate information
1084  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU: This frame is an A-MSDU frame
1085  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT: This frame is going through the fast_xmit path
1086  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP: This frame skips mesh path lookup
1087  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING: completely internal to mac80211,
1088  *	used to indicate that a pending frame requires TX processing before
1089  *	it can be sent out.
1090  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO: Do not overwrite the sequence number that
1091  *	has already been assigned to this frame.
1092  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER: This frame should not be reordered
1093  *	relative to other frames that have this flag set, independent
1094  *	of their QoS TID or other priority field values.
1095  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX: first MLO TX, used mostly internally
1096  *	for sequence number assignment
1097  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_USE_RATE_MASK: Don't use rate mask for this frame
1098  *	which is transmitted due to scanning or offchannel TX, not in normal
1099  *	operation on the interface.
1100  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK: If not @IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, this
1101  *	frame should be transmitted on the specific link. This really is
1102  *	only relevant for frames that do not have data present, and is
1103  *	also not used for 802.3 format frames. Note that even if the frame
1104  *	is on a specific link, address translation might still apply if
1105  *	it's intended for an MLD.
1106  *
1107  * These flags are used in tx_info->control.flags.
1108  */
1109 enum mac80211_tx_control_flags {
1110 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO	= BIT(0),
1111 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE		= BIT(1),
1112 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT		= BIT(2),
1113 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU			= BIT(3),
1114 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT		= BIT(4),
1115 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP	= BIT(5),
1116 	IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING	= BIT(6),
1117 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO		= BIT(7),
1118 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER		= BIT(8),
1119 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX	= BIT(9),
1120 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_USE_RATE_MASK	= BIT(10),
1121 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK		= 0xf0000000,
1122 };
1123 
1124 #define IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED	0xf
1125 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK_UNSPEC	\
1126 	u32_encode_bits(IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, \
1127 			IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK)
1128 
1129 /**
1130  * enum mac80211_tx_status_flags - flags to describe transmit status
1131  *
1132  * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID: ACK signal is valid
1133  *
1134  * These flags are used in tx_info->status.flags.
1135  */
1136 enum mac80211_tx_status_flags {
1137 	IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID = BIT(0),
1138 };
1139 
1140 /*
1141  * This definition is used as a mask to clear all temporary flags, which are
1142  * set by the tx handlers for each transmission attempt by the mac80211 stack.
1143  */
1144 #define IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS (IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK |		      \
1145 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT |    \
1146 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU |	      \
1147 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED |	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK |		      \
1148 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK |	      \
1149 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER |    \
1150 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC |		      \
1151 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC | IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
1152 
1153 /**
1154  * enum mac80211_rate_control_flags - per-rate flags set by the
1155  *	Rate Control algorithm.
1156  *
1157  * These flags are set by the Rate control algorithm for each rate during tx,
1158  * in the @flags member of struct ieee80211_tx_rate.
1159  *
1160  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS: Use RTS/CTS exchange for this rate.
1161  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT: CTS-to-self protection is required.
1162  *	This is set if the current BSS requires ERP protection.
1163  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Use short preamble.
1164  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS: HT rate.
1165  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS: VHT MCS rate, in this case the idx field is split
1166  *	into a higher 4 bits (Nss) and lower 4 bits (MCS number)
1167  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD: Indicates whether this rate should be used in
1168  *	Greenfield mode.
1169  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates if the Channel Width should be 40 MHz.
1170  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 80 MHz transmission
1171  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 160 MHz transmission
1172  *	(80+80 isn't supported yet)
1173  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA: The frame should be transmitted on both of the
1174  *	adjacent 20 MHz channels, if the current channel type is
1175  *	NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS or NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS.
1176  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI: Short Guard interval should be used for this rate.
1177  */
1178 enum mac80211_rate_control_flags {
1179 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS		= BIT(0),
1180 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT		= BIT(1),
1181 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE	= BIT(2),
1182 
1183 	/* rate index is an HT/VHT MCS instead of an index */
1184 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS			= BIT(3),
1185 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD		= BIT(4),
1186 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(5),
1187 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA		= BIT(6),
1188 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI		= BIT(7),
1189 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS			= BIT(8),
1190 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(9),
1191 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(10),
1192 };
1193 
1194 
1195 /* there are 40 bytes if you don't need the rateset to be kept */
1196 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 40
1197 
1198 /* if you do need the rateset, then you have less space */
1199 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 24
1200 
1201 /* maximum number of rate stages */
1202 #define IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES	4
1203 
1204 /* maximum number of rate table entries */
1205 #define IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE	4
1206 
1207 /**
1208  * struct ieee80211_tx_rate - rate selection/status
1209  *
1210  * @idx: rate index to attempt to send with
1211  * @flags: rate control flags (&enum mac80211_rate_control_flags)
1212  * @count: number of tries in this rate before going to the next rate
1213  *
1214  * A value of -1 for @idx indicates an invalid rate and, if used
1215  * in an array of retry rates, that no more rates should be tried.
1216  *
1217  * When used for transmit status reporting, the driver should
1218  * always report the rate along with the flags it used.
1219  *
1220  * &struct ieee80211_tx_info contains an array of these structs
1221  * in the control information, and it will be filled by the rate
1222  * control algorithm according to what should be sent. For example,
1223  * if this array contains, in the format { <idx>, <count> } the
1224  * information::
1225  *
1226  *    { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 4 }, { -1, 0 }, { -1, 0 }
1227  *
1228  * then this means that the frame should be transmitted
1229  * up to twice at rate 3, up to twice at rate 2, and up to four
1230  * times at rate 1 if it doesn't get acknowledged. Say it gets
1231  * acknowledged by the peer after the fifth attempt, the status
1232  * information should then contain::
1233  *
1234  *   { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 1 }, { -1, 0 } ...
1235  *
1236  * since it was transmitted twice at rate 3, twice at rate 2
1237  * and once at rate 1 after which we received an acknowledgement.
1238  */
1239 struct ieee80211_tx_rate {
1240 	s8 idx;
1241 	u16 count:5,
1242 	    flags:11;
1243 } __packed;
1244 
1245 #define IEEE80211_MAX_TX_RETRY		31
1246 
1247 static inline bool ieee80211_rate_valid(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1248 {
1249 	return rate->idx >= 0 && rate->count > 0;
1250 }
1251 
1252 static inline void ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate,
1253 					  u8 mcs, u8 nss)
1254 {
1255 	WARN_ON(mcs & ~0xF);
1256 	WARN_ON((nss - 1) & ~0x7);
1257 	rate->idx = ((nss - 1) << 4) | mcs;
1258 }
1259 
1260 static inline u8
1261 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1262 {
1263 	return rate->idx & 0xF;
1264 }
1265 
1266 static inline u8
1267 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1268 {
1269 	return (rate->idx >> 4) + 1;
1270 }
1271 
1272 /**
1273  * struct ieee80211_tx_info - skb transmit information
1274  *
1275  * This structure is placed in skb->cb for three uses:
1276  *  (1) mac80211 TX control - mac80211 tells the driver what to do
1277  *  (2) driver internal use (if applicable)
1278  *  (3) TX status information - driver tells mac80211 what happened
1279  *
1280  * @flags: transmit info flags, defined above
1281  * @band: the band to transmit on (use e.g. for checking for races),
1282  *	not valid if the interface is an MLD since we won't know which
1283  *	link the frame will be transmitted on
1284  * @hw_queue: HW queue to put the frame on, skb_get_queue_mapping() gives the AC
1285  * @status_data: internal data for TX status handling, assigned privately,
1286  *	see also &enum ieee80211_status_data for the internal documentation
1287  * @status_data_idr: indicates status data is IDR allocated ID for ack frame
1288  * @tx_time_est: TX time estimate in units of 4us, used internally
1289  * @control: union part for control data
1290  * @control.rates: TX rates array to try
1291  * @control.rts_cts_rate_idx: rate for RTS or CTS
1292  * @control.use_rts: use RTS
1293  * @control.use_cts_prot: use RTS/CTS
1294  * @control.short_preamble: use short preamble (CCK only)
1295  * @control.skip_table: skip externally configured rate table
1296  * @control.jiffies: timestamp for expiry on powersave clients
1297  * @control.vif: virtual interface (may be NULL)
1298  * @control.hw_key: key to encrypt with (may be NULL)
1299  * @control.flags: control flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_control_flags
1300  * @control.enqueue_time: enqueue time (for iTXQs)
1301  * @driver_rates: alias to @control.rates to reserve space
1302  * @pad: padding
1303  * @rate_driver_data: driver use area if driver needs @control.rates
1304  * @status: union part for status data
1305  * @status.rates: attempted rates
1306  * @status.ack_signal: ACK signal
1307  * @status.ampdu_ack_len: AMPDU ack length
1308  * @status.ampdu_len: AMPDU length
1309  * @status.antenna: (legacy, kept only for iwlegacy)
1310  * @status.tx_time: airtime consumed for transmission; note this is only
1311  *	used for WMM AC, not for airtime fairness
1312  * @status.flags: status flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_status_flags
1313  * @status.status_driver_data: driver use area
1314  * @ack: union part for pure ACK data
1315  * @ack.cookie: cookie for the ACK
1316  * @driver_data: array of driver_data pointers
1317  */
1318 struct ieee80211_tx_info {
1319 	/* common information */
1320 	u32 flags;
1321 	u32 band:3,
1322 	    status_data_idr:1,
1323 	    status_data:13,
1324 	    hw_queue:4,
1325 	    tx_time_est:10;
1326 	/* 1 free bit */
1327 
1328 	union {
1329 		struct {
1330 			union {
1331 				/* rate control */
1332 				struct {
1333 					struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[
1334 						IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1335 					s8 rts_cts_rate_idx;
1336 					u8 use_rts:1;
1337 					u8 use_cts_prot:1;
1338 					u8 short_preamble:1;
1339 					u8 skip_table:1;
1340 
1341 					/* for injection only (bitmap) */
1342 					u8 antennas:2;
1343 
1344 					/* 14 bits free */
1345 				};
1346 				/* only needed before rate control */
1347 				unsigned long jiffies;
1348 			};
1349 			/* NB: vif can be NULL for injected frames */
1350 			struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
1351 			struct ieee80211_key_conf *hw_key;
1352 			u32 flags;
1353 			codel_time_t enqueue_time;
1354 		} control;
1355 		struct {
1356 			u64 cookie;
1357 		} ack;
1358 		struct {
1359 			struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1360 			s32 ack_signal;
1361 			u8 ampdu_ack_len;
1362 			u8 ampdu_len;
1363 			u8 antenna;
1364 			u8 pad;
1365 			u16 tx_time;
1366 			u8 flags;
1367 			u8 pad2;
1368 			void *status_driver_data[16 / sizeof(void *)];
1369 		} status;
1370 		struct {
1371 			struct ieee80211_tx_rate driver_rates[
1372 				IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1373 			u8 pad[4];
1374 
1375 			void *rate_driver_data[
1376 				IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1377 		};
1378 		void *driver_data[
1379 			IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1380 	};
1381 };
1382 
1383 static inline u16
1384 ieee80211_info_set_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info, u16 tx_time_est)
1385 {
1386 	/* We only have 10 bits in tx_time_est, so store airtime
1387 	 * in increments of 4us and clamp the maximum to 2**12-1
1388 	 */
1389 	info->tx_time_est = min_t(u16, tx_time_est, 4095) >> 2;
1390 	return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1391 }
1392 
1393 static inline u16
1394 ieee80211_info_get_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1395 {
1396 	return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1397 }
1398 
1399 /***
1400  * struct ieee80211_rate_status - mrr stage for status path
1401  *
1402  * This struct is used in struct ieee80211_tx_status to provide drivers a
1403  * dynamic way to report about used rates and power levels per packet.
1404  *
1405  * @rate_idx The actual used rate.
1406  * @try_count How often the rate was tried.
1407  * @tx_power_idx An idx into the ieee80211_hw->tx_power_levels list of the
1408  * 	corresponding wifi hardware. The idx shall point to the power level
1409  * 	that was used when sending the packet.
1410  */
1411 struct ieee80211_rate_status {
1412 	struct rate_info rate_idx;
1413 	u8 try_count;
1414 	u8 tx_power_idx;
1415 };
1416 
1417 /**
1418  * struct ieee80211_tx_status - extended tx status info for rate control
1419  *
1420  * @sta: Station that the packet was transmitted for
1421  * @info: Basic tx status information
1422  * @skb: Packet skb (can be NULL if not provided by the driver)
1423  * @rates: Mrr stages that were used when sending the packet
1424  * @n_rates: Number of mrr stages (count of instances for @rates)
1425  * @free_list: list where processed skbs are stored to be free'd by the driver
1426  * @ack_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp of the received ack in nanoseconds
1427  *	Only needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action
1428  *	frames. Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1429  */
1430 struct ieee80211_tx_status {
1431 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
1432 	struct ieee80211_tx_info *info;
1433 	struct sk_buff *skb;
1434 	struct ieee80211_rate_status *rates;
1435 	ktime_t ack_hwtstamp;
1436 	u8 n_rates;
1437 
1438 	struct list_head *free_list;
1439 };
1440 
1441 /**
1442  * struct ieee80211_scan_ies - descriptors for different blocks of IEs
1443  *
1444  * This structure is used to point to different blocks of IEs in HW scan
1445  * and scheduled scan. These blocks contain the IEs passed by userspace
1446  * and the ones generated by mac80211.
1447  *
1448  * @ies: pointers to band specific IEs.
1449  * @len: lengths of band_specific IEs.
1450  * @common_ies: IEs for all bands (especially vendor specific ones)
1451  * @common_ie_len: length of the common_ies
1452  */
1453 struct ieee80211_scan_ies {
1454 	const u8 *ies[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1455 	size_t len[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1456 	const u8 *common_ies;
1457 	size_t common_ie_len;
1458 };
1459 
1460 
1461 static inline struct ieee80211_tx_info *IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1462 {
1463 	return (struct ieee80211_tx_info *)skb->cb;
1464 }
1465 
1466 static inline struct ieee80211_rx_status *IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1467 {
1468 	return (struct ieee80211_rx_status *)skb->cb;
1469 }
1470 
1471 /**
1472  * ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status - clear TX status
1473  *
1474  * @info: The &struct ieee80211_tx_info to be cleared.
1475  *
1476  * When the driver passes an skb back to mac80211, it must report
1477  * a number of things in TX status. This function clears everything
1478  * in the TX status but the rate control information (it does clear
1479  * the count since you need to fill that in anyway).
1480  *
1481  * NOTE: While the rates array is kept intact, this will wipe all of the
1482  *	 driver_data fields in info, so it's up to the driver to restore
1483  *	 any fields it needs after calling this helper.
1484  */
1485 static inline void
1486 ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1487 {
1488 	int i;
1489 
1490 	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1491 		     offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, control.rates));
1492 	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1493 		     offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, driver_rates));
1494 	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 8);
1495 	/* clear the rate counts */
1496 	for (i = 0; i < IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES; i++)
1497 		info->status.rates[i].count = 0;
1498 	memset_after(&info->status, 0, rates);
1499 }
1500 
1501 
1502 /**
1503  * enum mac80211_rx_flags - receive flags
1504  *
1505  * These flags are used with the @flag member of &struct ieee80211_rx_status.
1506  * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR: Michael MIC error was reported on this frame.
1507  *	Use together with %RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED.
1508  * @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED: This frame was decrypted in hardware.
1509  * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED: the Michael MIC is stripped off this frame,
1510  *	verification has been done by the hardware.
1511  * @RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED: The IV and ICV are stripped from this frame.
1512  *	If this flag is set, the stack cannot do any replay detection
1513  *	hence the driver or hardware will have to do that.
1514  * @RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED: Currently only valid for CCMP/GCMP frames, this
1515  *	flag indicates that the PN was verified for replay protection.
1516  *	Note that this flag is also currently only supported when a frame
1517  *	is also decrypted (ie. @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED must be set)
1518  * @RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED: The driver should set this flag if it did
1519  *	de-duplication by itself.
1520  * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC: Set this flag if the FCS check failed on
1521  *	the frame.
1522  * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC: Set this flag if the PCLP check failed on
1523  *	the frame.
1524  * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1525  *	field) is valid if this field is non-zero, and the position
1526  *	where the timestamp was sampled depends on the value.
1527  * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1528  *	field) is valid and contains the time the first symbol of the MPDU
1529  *	was received. This is useful in monitor mode and for proper IBSS
1530  *	merging.
1531  * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1532  *	field) is valid and contains the time the last symbol of the MPDU
1533  *	(including FCS) was received.
1534  * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1535  *	field) is valid and contains the time the SYNC preamble was received.
1536  * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_IS_RTAP_TS64: The timestamp passed in the RX status @mactime
1537  *	is only for use in the radiotap timestamp header, not otherwise a valid
1538  *	@mactime value. Note this is a separate flag so that we continue to see
1539  *	%RX_FLAG_MACTIME as unset. Also note that in this case the timestamp is
1540  *	reported to be 64 bits wide, not just 32.
1541  * @RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL: The signal strength value is not present.
1542  *	Valid only for data frames (mainly A-MPDU)
1543  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS: A-MPDU details are known, in particular the reference
1544  *	number (@ampdu_reference) must be populated and be a distinct number for
1545  *	each A-MPDU
1546  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN: last subframe is known, should be set on all
1547  *	subframes of a single A-MPDU
1548  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST: this subframe is the last subframe of the A-MPDU
1549  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR: A delimiter CRC error has been detected
1550  *	on this subframe
1551  * @RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED: The mic was stripped of this packet. Decryption was
1552  *	done by the hardware
1553  * @RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR: Report frame only to monitor interfaces without
1554  *	processing it in any regular way.
1555  *	This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1556  *	them for sniffing purposes.
1557  * @RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR: Process and report frame to all interfaces except
1558  *	monitor interfaces.
1559  *	This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1560  *	them for sniffing purposes.
1561  * @RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE: Some drivers may prefer to report separate A-MSDU
1562  *	subframes instead of a one huge frame for performance reasons.
1563  *	All, but the last MSDU from an A-MSDU should have this flag set. E.g.
1564  *	if an A-MSDU has 3 frames, the first 2 must have the flag set, while
1565  *	the 3rd (last) one must not have this flag set. The flag is used to
1566  *	deal with retransmission/duplication recovery properly since A-MSDU
1567  *	subframes share the same sequence number. Reported subframes can be
1568  *	either regular MSDU or singly A-MSDUs. Subframes must not be
1569  *	interleaved with other frames.
1570  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END: This frame contains radiotap TLVs in the
1571  *	skb->data (before the 802.11 header).
1572  *	If used, the SKB's mac_header pointer must be set to point
1573  *	to the 802.11 header after the TLVs, and any padding added after TLV
1574  *	data to align to 4 must be cleared by the driver putting the TLVs
1575  *	in the skb.
1576  * @RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN: Allow the same PN as same packet before.
1577  *	This is used for AMSDU subframes which can have the same PN as
1578  *	the first subframe.
1579  * @RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED: The ICV is stripped from this frame. CRC checking must
1580  *	be done in the hardware.
1581  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT: Value of the EOF bit in the A-MPDU delimiter for this
1582  *	frame
1583  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN: The EOF value is known
1584  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE: HE radiotap data is present
1585  *	(&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he, mac80211 will fill in
1586  *
1587  *	 - DATA3_DATA_MCS
1588  *	 - DATA3_DATA_DCM
1589  *	 - DATA3_CODING
1590  *	 - DATA5_GI
1591  *	 - DATA5_DATA_BW_RU_ALLOC
1592  *	 - DATA6_NSTS
1593  *	 - DATA3_STBC
1594  *
1595  *	from the RX info data, so leave those zeroed when building this data)
1596  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU: HE MU radiotap data is present
1597  *	(&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he_mu)
1598  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG: L-SIG radiotap data is present
1599  * @RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU: use the frame only for radiotap reporting, with
1600  *	the "0-length PSDU" field included there.  The value for it is
1601  *	in &struct ieee80211_rx_status.  Note that if this value isn't
1602  *	known the frame shouldn't be reported.
1603  * @RX_FLAG_8023: the frame has an 802.3 header (decap offload performed by
1604  *	hardware or driver)
1605  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_VHT: VHT radiotap data is present
1606  */
1607 enum mac80211_rx_flags {
1608 	RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR		= BIT(0),
1609 	RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED		= BIT(1),
1610 	RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR		= BIT(2),
1611 	RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED		= BIT(3),
1612 	RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED		= BIT(4),
1613 	RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC		= BIT(5),
1614 	RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC 	= BIT(6),
1615 	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_IS_RTAP_TS64	= BIT(7),
1616 	RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL		= BIT(8),
1617 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS		= BIT(9),
1618 	RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED		= BIT(10),
1619 	RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED		= BIT(11),
1620 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN	= BIT(12),
1621 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST		= BIT(13),
1622 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR	= BIT(14),
1623 	/* one free bit at 15 */
1624 	RX_FLAG_MACTIME			= BIT(16) | BIT(17),
1625 	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START	= 1 << 16,
1626 	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START		= 2 << 16,
1627 	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END		= 3 << 16,
1628 	RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR		= BIT(18),
1629 	RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE		= BIT(19),
1630 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END	= BIT(20),
1631 	RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED		= BIT(21),
1632 	RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN		= BIT(22),
1633 	RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED		= BIT(23),
1634 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT		= BIT(24),
1635 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN	= BIT(25),
1636 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE		= BIT(26),
1637 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU		= BIT(27),
1638 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG		= BIT(28),
1639 	RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU			= BIT(29),
1640 	RX_FLAG_8023			= BIT(30),
1641 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_VHT		= BIT(31),
1642 };
1643 
1644 /**
1645  * enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags - MCS & bandwidth flags
1646  *
1647  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE: Short preamble was used for this frame
1648  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI: Short guard interval was used
1649  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF: This frame was received in a HT-greenfield transmission,
1650  *	if the driver fills this value it should add
1651  *	%IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_FMT
1652  *	to @hw.radiotap_mcs_details to advertise that fact.
1653  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC: LDPC was used
1654  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK: STBC 2 bit bitmask. 1 - Nss=1, 2 - Nss=2, 3 - Nss=3
1655  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_BF: packet was beamformed
1656  */
1657 enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags {
1658 	RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE		= BIT(0),
1659 	RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI		= BIT(2),
1660 	RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF		= BIT(3),
1661 	RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK		= BIT(4) | BIT(5),
1662 	RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC		= BIT(6),
1663 	RX_ENC_FLAG_BF			= BIT(7),
1664 };
1665 
1666 #define RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_SHIFT		4
1667 
1668 enum mac80211_rx_encoding {
1669 	RX_ENC_LEGACY = 0,
1670 	RX_ENC_HT,
1671 	RX_ENC_VHT,
1672 	RX_ENC_HE,
1673 	RX_ENC_EHT,
1674 	RX_ENC_UHR,
1675 };
1676 
1677 /**
1678  * struct ieee80211_rx_status - receive status
1679  *
1680  * The low-level driver should provide this information (the subset
1681  * supported by hardware) to the 802.11 code with each received
1682  * frame, in the skb's control buffer (cb).
1683  *
1684  * @mactime: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization Function
1685  * 	(TSF) timer when the first data symbol (MPDU) arrived at the hardware.
1686  * @boottime_ns: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp the frame was received at, this is
1687  *	needed only for beacons and probe responses that update the scan cache.
1688  * @ack_tx_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp for the ack TX in nanoseconds. Only
1689  *	needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action frames.
1690  *	Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1691  * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, mac80211 doesn't use
1692  *	it but can store it and pass it back to the driver for synchronisation
1693  * @band: the active band when this frame was received
1694  * @freq: frequency the radio was tuned to when receiving this frame, in MHz
1695  *	This field must be set for management frames, but isn't strictly needed
1696  *	for data (other) frames - for those it only affects radiotap reporting.
1697  * @freq_offset: @freq has a positive offset of 500Khz.
1698  * @signal: signal strength when receiving this frame, either in dBm, in dB or
1699  *	unspecified depending on the hardware capabilities flags
1700  *	@IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_*
1701  * @chains: bitmask of receive chains for which separate signal strength
1702  *	values were filled.
1703  * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength, in dBm (unlike @signal, doesn't
1704  *	support dB or unspecified units)
1705  * @antenna: antenna used
1706  * @rate_idx: index of data rate into band's supported rates or MCS index if
1707  *	HT or VHT is used (%RX_FLAG_HT/%RX_FLAG_VHT)
1708  * @nss: number of streams (VHT, HE, EHT and UHR only)
1709  * @flag: %RX_FLAG_\*
1710  * @encoding: &enum mac80211_rx_encoding
1711  * @bw: &enum rate_info_bw
1712  * @enc_flags: uses bits from &enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags
1713  * @he_ru: HE RU, from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc
1714  * @he_gi: HE GI, from &enum nl80211_he_gi
1715  * @he_dcm: HE DCM value
1716  * @eht: EHT specific rate information
1717  * @eht.ru: EHT RU, from &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc
1718  * @eht.gi: EHT GI, from &enum nl80211_eht_gi
1719  * @uhr: UHR specific rate information
1720  * @uhr.ru: UHR RU, from &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc
1721  * @uhr.gi: UHR GI, from &enum nl80211_eht_gi
1722  * @uhr.elr: UHR ELR MCS was used
1723  * @uhr.im: UHR interference mitigation was used
1724  * @rx_flags: internal RX flags for mac80211
1725  * @ampdu_reference: A-MPDU reference number, must be a different value for
1726  *	each A-MPDU but the same for each subframe within one A-MPDU
1727  * @zero_length_psdu_type: radiotap type of the 0-length PSDU
1728  * @link_valid: if the link which is identified by @link_id is valid. This flag
1729  *	is set only when connection is MLO.
1730  * @link_id: id of the link used to receive the packet. This is used along with
1731  *	@link_valid.
1732  */
1733 struct ieee80211_rx_status {
1734 	u64 mactime;
1735 	union {
1736 		u64 boottime_ns;
1737 		ktime_t ack_tx_hwtstamp;
1738 	};
1739 	u32 device_timestamp;
1740 	u32 ampdu_reference;
1741 	u32 flag;
1742 	u16 freq: 13, freq_offset: 1;
1743 	u8 enc_flags;
1744 	u8 encoding:3, bw:4;
1745 	union {
1746 		struct {
1747 			u8 he_ru:3;
1748 			u8 he_gi:2;
1749 			u8 he_dcm:1;
1750 		};
1751 		struct {
1752 			u8 ru:4;
1753 			u8 gi:2;
1754 		} eht;
1755 		struct {
1756 			u8 ru:4;
1757 			u8 gi:2;
1758 			u8 elr:1;
1759 			u8 im:1;
1760 		} uhr;
1761 	};
1762 	u8 rate_idx;
1763 	u8 nss;
1764 	u8 rx_flags;
1765 	u8 band;
1766 	u8 antenna;
1767 	s8 signal;
1768 	u8 chains;
1769 	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
1770 	u8 zero_length_psdu_type;
1771 	u8 link_valid:1, link_id:4;
1772 };
1773 
1774 static inline u32
1775 ieee80211_rx_status_to_khz(struct ieee80211_rx_status *rx_status)
1776 {
1777 	return MHZ_TO_KHZ(rx_status->freq) +
1778 	       (rx_status->freq_offset ? 500 : 0);
1779 }
1780 
1781 /**
1782  * enum ieee80211_conf_flags - configuration flags
1783  *
1784  * Flags to define PHY configuration options
1785  *
1786  * @IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR: there's a monitor interface present -- use this
1787  *	to determine for example whether to calculate timestamps for packets
1788  *	or not, do not use instead of filter flags!
1789  * @IEEE80211_CONF_PS: Enable 802.11 power save mode (managed mode only).
1790  *	This is the power save mode defined by IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2,
1791  *	meaning that the hardware still wakes up for beacons, is able to
1792  *	transmit frames and receive the possible acknowledgment frames.
1793  *	Not to be confused with hardware specific wakeup/sleep states,
1794  *	driver is responsible for that. See the section "Powersave support"
1795  *	for more.
1796  * @IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE: The device is running, but idle; if the flag is set
1797  *	the driver should be prepared to handle configuration requests but
1798  *	may turn the device off as much as possible. Typically, this flag will
1799  *	be set when an interface is set UP but not associated or scanning, but
1800  *	it can also be unset in that case when monitor interfaces are active.
1801  * @IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL: The device is currently not on its main
1802  *	operating channel.
1803  */
1804 enum ieee80211_conf_flags {
1805 	IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR		= (1<<0),
1806 	IEEE80211_CONF_PS		= (1<<1),
1807 	IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE		= (1<<2),
1808 	IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL	= (1<<3),
1809 };
1810 
1811 
1812 /**
1813  * enum ieee80211_conf_changed - denotes which configuration changed
1814  *
1815  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL: the listen interval changed
1816  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR: the monitor flag changed
1817  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS: the PS flag or dynamic PS timeout changed
1818  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER: the TX power changed
1819  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL: the channel/channel_type changed
1820  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS: retry limits changed
1821  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE: Idle flag changed
1822  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS: Spatial multiplexing powersave mode changed
1823  *	Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1824  *	otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1825  */
1826 enum ieee80211_conf_changed {
1827 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS		= BIT(1),
1828 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL	= BIT(2),
1829 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR		= BIT(3),
1830 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS		= BIT(4),
1831 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER		= BIT(5),
1832 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL		= BIT(6),
1833 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS	= BIT(7),
1834 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE		= BIT(8),
1835 };
1836 
1837 /**
1838  * enum ieee80211_smps_mode - spatial multiplexing power save mode
1839  *
1840  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC: automatic
1841  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF: off
1842  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC: static
1843  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic
1844  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES: internal, don't use
1845  */
1846 enum ieee80211_smps_mode {
1847 	IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC,
1848 	IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF,
1849 	IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC,
1850 	IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC,
1851 
1852 	/* keep last */
1853 	IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES,
1854 };
1855 
1856 /**
1857  * struct ieee80211_conf - configuration of the device
1858  *
1859  * This struct indicates how the driver shall configure the hardware.
1860  *
1861  * @flags: configuration flags defined above
1862  *
1863  * @listen_interval: listen interval in units of beacon interval
1864  * @ps_dtim_period: The DTIM period of the AP we're connected to, for use
1865  *	in power saving. Power saving will not be enabled until a beacon
1866  *	has been received and the DTIM period is known.
1867  * @dynamic_ps_timeout: The dynamic powersave timeout (in ms), see the
1868  *	powersave documentation below. This variable is valid only when
1869  *	the CONF_PS flag is set.
1870  *
1871  * @power_level: requested transmit power (in dBm), backward compatibility
1872  *	value only that is set to the minimum of all interfaces
1873  *
1874  * @chandef: the channel definition to tune to
1875  * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled
1876  *
1877  * @long_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "long" frame
1878  *	(a frame not RTS protected), called "dot11LongRetryLimit" in 802.11,
1879  *	but actually means the number of transmissions not the number of retries
1880  * @short_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "short"
1881  *	frame, called "dot11ShortRetryLimit" in 802.11, but actually means the
1882  *	number of transmissions not the number of retries
1883  *
1884  * @smps_mode: spatial multiplexing powersave mode; note that
1885  *	%IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC is used when the device is not
1886  *	configured for an HT channel.
1887  *	Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1888  *	otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1889  */
1890 struct ieee80211_conf {
1891 	u32 flags;
1892 	int power_level, dynamic_ps_timeout;
1893 
1894 	u16 listen_interval;
1895 	u8 ps_dtim_period;
1896 
1897 	u8 long_frame_max_tx_count, short_frame_max_tx_count;
1898 
1899 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1900 	bool radar_enabled;
1901 	enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
1902 };
1903 
1904 /**
1905  * struct ieee80211_channel_switch - holds the channel switch data
1906  *
1907  * The information provided in this structure is required for channel switch
1908  * operation.
1909  *
1910  * @timestamp: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization
1911  *	Function (TSF) timer when the frame containing the channel switch
1912  *	announcement was received. This is simply the rx.mactime parameter
1913  *	the driver passed into mac80211.
1914  * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, this is the
1915  *	rx.device_timestamp parameter the driver passed to mac80211.
1916  * @block_tx: Indicates whether transmission must be blocked before the
1917  *	scheduled channel switch, as indicated by the AP.
1918  * @chandef: the new channel to switch to
1919  * @count: the number of TBTT's until the channel switch event
1920  * @delay: maximum delay between the time the AP transmitted the last beacon in
1921  *	current channel and the expected time of the first beacon in the new
1922  *	channel, expressed in TU.
1923  * @link_id: the link ID of the link doing the channel switch, 0 for non-MLO
1924  */
1925 struct ieee80211_channel_switch {
1926 	u64 timestamp;
1927 	u32 device_timestamp;
1928 	bool block_tx;
1929 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1930 	u8 count;
1931 	u8 link_id;
1932 	u32 delay;
1933 };
1934 
1935 /**
1936  * enum ieee80211_vif_flags - virtual interface flags
1937  *
1938  * @IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER: the device performs beacon filtering
1939  *	on this virtual interface to avoid unnecessary CPU wakeups
1940  * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI: the device can do connection quality
1941  *	monitoring on this virtual interface -- i.e. it can monitor
1942  *	connection quality related parameters, such as the RSSI level and
1943  *	provide notifications if configured trigger levels are reached.
1944  * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD: The device can do U-APSD for this
1945  *	interface. This flag should be set during interface addition,
1946  *	but may be set/cleared as late as authentication to an AP. It is
1947  *	only valid for managed/station mode interfaces.
1948  * @IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE: request to handle NOA attributes
1949  *	and send P2P_PS notification to the driver if NOA changed, even
1950  *	this is not pure P2P vif.
1951  * @IEEE80211_VIF_EML_ACTIVE: The driver indicates that EML operation is
1952  *      enabled for the interface.
1953  * @IEEE80211_VIF_IGNORE_OFDMA_WIDER_BW: Ignore wider bandwidth OFDMA
1954  *	operation on this interface and request a channel context without
1955  *	the AP definition. Use this e.g. because the device is able to
1956  *	handle OFDMA (downlink and trigger for uplink) on a per-AP basis.
1957  * @IEEE80211_VIF_REMOVE_AP_AFTER_DISASSOC: indicates that the AP sta should
1958  *	be removed only after setting the vif as unassociated, and not the
1959  *	opposite. Only relevant for STA vifs.
1960  */
1961 enum ieee80211_vif_flags {
1962 	IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER		= BIT(0),
1963 	IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI		= BIT(1),
1964 	IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD		= BIT(2),
1965 	IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE		= BIT(3),
1966 	IEEE80211_VIF_EML_ACTIVE	        = BIT(4),
1967 	IEEE80211_VIF_IGNORE_OFDMA_WIDER_BW	= BIT(5),
1968 	IEEE80211_VIF_REMOVE_AP_AFTER_DISASSOC	= BIT(6),
1969 };
1970 
1971 
1972 /**
1973  * enum ieee80211_offload_flags - virtual interface offload flags
1974  *
1975  * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED: tx encapsulation offload is enabled
1976  *	The driver supports sending frames passed as 802.3 frames by mac80211.
1977  *	It must also support sending 802.11 packets for the same interface.
1978  * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR: support 4-address mode encapsulation offload
1979  * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED: rx encapsulation offload is enabled
1980  *	The driver supports passing received 802.11 frames as 802.3 frames to
1981  *	mac80211.
1982  */
1983 
1984 enum ieee80211_offload_flags {
1985 	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED		= BIT(0),
1986 	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR		= BIT(1),
1987 	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED		= BIT(2),
1988 };
1989 
1990 #define IEEE80211_NAN_AVAIL_BLOB_MAX_LEN	54
1991 
1992 /**
1993  * struct ieee80211_eml_params - EHT Operating mode notification parameters
1994  *
1995  * EML Operating mode notification parameters received in the Operating mode
1996  * notification frame. This struct is used as a container to pass the info to
1997  * the underlay driver.
1998  *
1999  * @link_id: the link ID where the Operating mode notification frame has been
2000  *	received.
2001  * @control: EML control field defined in P802.11be section 9.4.1.76.
2002  * @link_bitmap: eMLSR/eMLMR enabled links defined in P802.11be
2003  *	section 9.4.1.76.
2004  * @emlmr_mcs_map_count: eMLMR number of valid mcs_map_bw fields according to
2005  *	P802.11be section 9.4.1.76 (valid if eMLMR mode control bit is set).
2006  * @emlmr_mcs_map_bw: eMLMR supported MCS and NSS set subfileds defined in
2007  *	P802.11be section 9.4.1.76 (valid if eMLMR mode control bit is set).
2008  */
2009 struct ieee80211_eml_params {
2010 	u8 link_id;
2011 	u8 control;
2012 	u16 link_bitmap;
2013 	u8 emlmr_mcs_map_count;
2014 	u8 emlmr_mcs_map_bw[9];
2015 };
2016 
2017 /**
2018  * struct ieee80211_nan_sched_cfg - NAN schedule configuration
2019  * @channels: array of NAN channels. A channel entry is in use if
2020  *	channels[i].chanreq.oper.chan is not NULL.
2021  * @schedule: NAN local schedule - mapping of each 16TU time slot to
2022  *	the NAN channel on which the radio will operate. NULL if unscheduled.
2023  * @avail_blob: NAN Availability attribute blob.
2024  * @avail_blob_len: length of the @avail_blob in bytes.
2025  * @deferred: indicates that the driver should notify peers before applying the
2026  *	new NAN schedule, and apply the new schedule the second NAN Slot
2027  *	boundary after it notified the peers, as defined in Wi-Fi Aware (TM) 4.0
2028  *	specification, section 5.2.2.
2029  *	The driver must call ieee80211_nan_sched_update_done() after the
2030  *	schedule has been applied.
2031  *	If a HW restart happened while a deferred schedule update was pending,
2032  *	mac80211 will reconfigure the deferred schedule (and wait for the driver
2033  *	to notify that the schedule has been applied).
2034  */
2035 struct ieee80211_nan_sched_cfg {
2036 	struct ieee80211_nan_channel channels[IEEE80211_NAN_MAX_CHANNELS];
2037 	struct ieee80211_nan_channel *schedule[CFG80211_NAN_SCHED_NUM_TIME_SLOTS];
2038 	u8 avail_blob[IEEE80211_NAN_AVAIL_BLOB_MAX_LEN];
2039 	u16 avail_blob_len;
2040 	bool deferred;
2041 };
2042 
2043 /**
2044  * struct ieee80211_vif_cfg - interface configuration
2045  * @assoc: association status
2046  * @ibss_joined: indicates whether this station is part of an IBSS or not
2047  * @ibss_creator: indicates if a new IBSS network is being created
2048  * @ps: power-save mode (STA only). This flag is NOT affected by
2049  *	offchannel/dynamic_ps operations.
2050  * @aid: association ID number, valid only when @assoc is true
2051  * @eml_cap: EML capabilities as described in P802.11be_D4.1 Figure 9-1001j.
2052  * @eml_med_sync_delay: Medium Synchronization delay as described in
2053  *	P802.11be_D4.1 Figure 9-1001i.
2054  * @mld_capa_op: MLD Capabilities and Operations per P802.11be_D4.1
2055  *	Figure 9-1001k
2056  * @arp_addr_list: List of IPv4 addresses for hardware ARP filtering. The
2057  *	may filter ARP queries targeted for other addresses than listed here.
2058  *	The driver must allow ARP queries targeted for all address listed here
2059  *	to pass through. An empty list implies no ARP queries need to pass.
2060  * @arp_addr_cnt: Number of addresses currently on the list. Note that this
2061  *	may be larger than %IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN (the arp_addr_list
2062  *	array size), it's up to the driver what to do in that case.
2063  * @ssid: The SSID of the current vif. Valid in AP and IBSS mode.
2064  * @ssid_len: Length of SSID given in @ssid.
2065  * @s1g: BSS is S1G BSS (affects Association Request format).
2066  * @idle: This interface is idle. There's also a global idle flag in the
2067  *	hardware config which may be more appropriate depending on what
2068  *	your driver/device needs to do.
2069  * @ap_addr: AP MLD address, or BSSID for non-MLO connections
2070  *	(station mode only)
2071  * @nan_sched: NAN schedule parameters. &struct ieee80211_nan_sched_cfg
2072  */
2073 struct ieee80211_vif_cfg {
2074 	/* association related data */
2075 	bool assoc, ibss_joined;
2076 	bool ibss_creator;
2077 	bool ps;
2078 	u16 aid;
2079 	u16 eml_cap;
2080 	u16 eml_med_sync_delay;
2081 	u16 mld_capa_op;
2082 
2083 	__be32 arp_addr_list[IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN];
2084 	int arp_addr_cnt;
2085 	u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
2086 	size_t ssid_len;
2087 	bool s1g;
2088 	bool idle;
2089 	u8 ap_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2090 	/* Protected by the wiphy mutex */
2091 	struct ieee80211_nan_sched_cfg nan_sched;
2092 };
2093 
2094 #define IEEE80211_TTLM_NUM_TIDS 8
2095 
2096 /**
2097  * struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm - negotiated TID to link map info
2098  *
2099  * @downlink: bitmap of active links per TID for downlink, or 0 if mapping for
2100  *	this TID is not included.
2101  * @uplink: bitmap of active links per TID for uplink, or 0 if mapping for this
2102  *	TID is not included.
2103  * @valid: info is valid or not.
2104  */
2105 struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm {
2106 	u16 downlink[IEEE80211_TTLM_NUM_TIDS];
2107 	u16 uplink[IEEE80211_TTLM_NUM_TIDS];
2108 	bool valid;
2109 };
2110 
2111 /**
2112  * enum ieee80211_neg_ttlm_res - return value for negotiated TTLM handling
2113  * @NEG_TTLM_RES_ACCEPT: accept the request
2114  * @NEG_TTLM_RES_REJECT: reject the request
2115  * @NEG_TTLM_RES_SUGGEST_PREFERRED: reject and suggest a new mapping
2116  */
2117 enum ieee80211_neg_ttlm_res {
2118 	NEG_TTLM_RES_ACCEPT,
2119 	NEG_TTLM_RES_REJECT,
2120 	NEG_TTLM_RES_SUGGEST_PREFERRED
2121 };
2122 
2123 /**
2124  * struct ieee80211_vif - per-interface data
2125  *
2126  * Data in this structure is continually present for driver
2127  * use during the life of a virtual interface.
2128  *
2129  * @type: type of this virtual interface
2130  * @cfg: vif configuration, see &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg
2131  * @bss_conf: BSS configuration for this interface, either our own
2132  *	or the BSS we're associated to
2133  * @link_conf: in case of MLD, the per-link BSS configuration,
2134  *	indexed by link ID
2135  * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO.
2136  * @active_links: The bitmap of active links, or 0 for non-MLO.
2137  *	The driver shouldn't change this directly, but use the
2138  *	API calls meant for that purpose.
2139  * @dormant_links: subset of the valid links that are disabled/suspended
2140  *	due to advertised or negotiated TTLM respectively.
2141  *	0 for non-MLO.
2142  * @suspended_links: subset of dormant_links representing links that are
2143  *	suspended due to negotiated TTLM, and could be activated in the
2144  *	future by tearing down the TTLM negotiation.
2145  *	0 for non-MLO.
2146  * @neg_ttlm: negotiated TID to link mapping info.
2147  *	see &struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm.
2148  * @addr: address of this interface
2149  * @addr_valid: indicates if the address is actively used. Set to false for
2150  *	passive monitor interfaces, true in all other cases.
2151  * @p2p: indicates whether this AP or STA interface is a p2p
2152  *	interface, i.e. a GO or p2p-sta respectively
2153  * @netdev_features: tx netdev features supported by the hardware for this
2154  *	vif. mac80211 initializes this to hw->netdev_features, and the driver
2155  *	can mask out specific tx features. mac80211 will handle software fixup
2156  *	for masked offloads (GSO, CSUM)
2157  * @driver_flags: flags/capabilities the driver has for this interface,
2158  *	these need to be set (or cleared) when the interface is added
2159  *	or, if supported by the driver, the interface type is changed
2160  *	at runtime, mac80211 will never touch this field
2161  * @offload_flags: hardware offload capabilities/flags for this interface.
2162  *	These are initialized by mac80211 before calling .add_interface,
2163  *	.change_interface or .update_vif_offload and updated by the driver
2164  *	within these ops, based on supported features or runtime change
2165  *	restrictions.
2166  * @hw_queue: hardware queue for each AC
2167  * @cab_queue: content-after-beacon (DTIM beacon really) queue, AP mode only
2168  * @debugfs_dir: debugfs dentry, can be used by drivers to create own per
2169  *	interface debug files. Note that it will be NULL for the virtual
2170  *	monitor interface (if that is requested.)
2171  * @probe_req_reg: probe requests should be reported to mac80211 for this
2172  *	interface.
2173  * @rx_mcast_action_reg: multicast Action frames should be reported to mac80211
2174  *	for this interface.
2175  * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
2176  *	sizeof(void \*).
2177  * @txq: the multicast data TX queue
2178  * @txq_mgmt: the mgmt frame TX queue, currently only exists for NAN devices
2179  * @offload_flags: 802.3 -> 802.11 enapsulation offload flags, see
2180  *	&enum ieee80211_offload_flags.
2181  */
2182 struct ieee80211_vif {
2183 	enum nl80211_iftype type;
2184 	struct ieee80211_vif_cfg cfg;
2185 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf bss_conf;
2186 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf __rcu *link_conf[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
2187 	u16 valid_links, active_links, dormant_links, suspended_links;
2188 	struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm neg_ttlm;
2189 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2190 	bool addr_valid;
2191 	bool p2p;
2192 
2193 	u8 cab_queue;
2194 	u8 hw_queue[IEEE80211_NUM_ACS];
2195 
2196 	struct ieee80211_txq *txq;
2197 	struct ieee80211_txq *txq_mgmt;
2198 
2199 	netdev_features_t netdev_features;
2200 	u32 driver_flags;
2201 	u32 offload_flags;
2202 
2203 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
2204 	struct dentry *debugfs_dir;
2205 #endif
2206 
2207 	bool probe_req_reg;
2208 	bool rx_mcast_action_reg;
2209 
2210 	/* must be last */
2211 	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2212 };
2213 
2214 /**
2215  * ieee80211_vif_usable_links - Return the usable links for the vif
2216  * @vif: the vif for which the usable links are requested
2217  * Return: the usable link bitmap
2218  */
2219 static inline u16 ieee80211_vif_usable_links(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2220 {
2221 	return vif->valid_links & ~vif->dormant_links;
2222 }
2223 
2224 /**
2225  * ieee80211_vif_is_mld - Returns true iff the vif is an MLD one
2226  * @vif: the vif
2227  * Return: %true if the vif is an MLD, %false otherwise.
2228  */
2229 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mld(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2230 {
2231 	/* valid_links != 0 indicates this vif is an MLD */
2232 	return vif->valid_links != 0;
2233 }
2234 
2235 /**
2236  * ieee80211_vif_link_active - check if a given link is active
2237  * @vif: the vif
2238  * @link_id: the link ID to check
2239  * Return: %true if the vif is an MLD and the link is active, or if
2240  *	the vif is not an MLD and the link ID is 0; %false otherwise.
2241  */
2242 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_link_active(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
2243 					     unsigned int link_id)
2244 {
2245 	if (!ieee80211_vif_is_mld(vif))
2246 		return link_id == 0;
2247 	return vif->active_links & BIT(link_id);
2248 }
2249 
2250 #define for_each_vif_active_link(vif, link, link_id)				\
2251 	for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((vif)->link_conf); link_id++)	\
2252 		if ((!(vif)->active_links ||					\
2253 		     (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) &&			\
2254 		    (link = link_conf_dereference_check(vif, link_id)))
2255 
2256 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2257 {
2258 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_MESH
2259 	return vif->type == NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT;
2260 #endif
2261 	return false;
2262 }
2263 
2264 /**
2265  * wdev_to_ieee80211_vif - return a vif struct from a wdev
2266  * @wdev: the wdev to get the vif for
2267  *
2268  * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
2269  * (like the vendor commands) that get a wdev.
2270  *
2271  * Return: pointer to the wdev, or %NULL if the given wdev isn't
2272  * associated with a vif that the driver knows about (e.g. monitor
2273  * or AP_VLAN interfaces.)
2274  */
2275 struct ieee80211_vif *wdev_to_ieee80211_vif(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
2276 
2277 /**
2278  * ieee80211_vif_to_wdev - return a wdev struct from a vif
2279  * @vif: the vif to get the wdev for
2280  *
2281  * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
2282  * (like the vendor commands) that needs to get the wdev for a vif.
2283  * This can also be useful to get the netdev associated to a vif.
2284  *
2285  * Return: pointer to the wdev
2286  */
2287 struct wireless_dev *ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
2288 
2289 static inline bool lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2290 {
2291 	return lockdep_is_held(&ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(vif)->wiphy->mtx);
2292 }
2293 
2294 #define link_conf_dereference_protected(vif, link_id)		\
2295 	rcu_dereference_protected((vif)->link_conf[link_id],	\
2296 				  lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(vif))
2297 
2298 #define link_conf_dereference_check(vif, link_id)		\
2299 	rcu_dereference_check((vif)->link_conf[link_id],	\
2300 			      lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(vif))
2301 
2302 /**
2303  * enum ieee80211_key_flags - key flags
2304  *
2305  * These flags are used for communication about keys between the driver
2306  * and mac80211, with the @flags parameter of &struct ieee80211_key_conf.
2307  *
2308  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV: This flag should be set by the
2309  *	driver to indicate that it requires IV generation for this
2310  *	particular key. Setting this flag does not necessarily mean that SKBs
2311  *	will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or MIC.
2312  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC: This flag should be set by
2313  *	the driver for a TKIP key if it requires Michael MIC
2314  *	generation in software.
2315  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE: Set by mac80211, this flag indicates
2316  *	that the key is pairwise rather then a shared key.
2317  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX: This flag should be set by the driver for a
2318  *	CCMP/GCMP key if it requires CCMP/GCMP encryption of management frames
2319  *	(MFP) to be done in software.
2320  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver
2321  *	if space should be prepared for the IV, but the IV
2322  *	itself should not be generated. Do not set together with
2323  *	@IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV on the same key. Setting this flag does
2324  *	not necessarily mean that SKBs will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or
2325  *	MIC.
2326  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT: This key will be used to decrypt received
2327  *	management frames. The flag can help drivers that have a hardware
2328  *	crypto implementation that doesn't deal with management frames
2329  *	properly by allowing them to not upload the keys to hardware and
2330  *	fall back to software crypto. Note that this flag deals only with
2331  *	RX, if your crypto engine can't deal with TX you can also set the
2332  *	%IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX flag to encrypt such frames in SW.
2333  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT: This flag should be set by the
2334  *	driver for a CCMP/GCMP key to indicate that is requires IV generation
2335  *	only for management frames (MFP).
2336  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM: This flag should be set by the
2337  *	driver for a key to indicate that sufficient tailroom must always
2338  *	be reserved for ICV or MIC, even when HW encryption is enabled.
2339  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver for
2340  *	a TKIP key if it only requires MIC space. Do not set together with
2341  *	@IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC on the same key.
2342  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX: Key needs explicit Tx activation.
2343  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE: This flag should be set by the driver
2344  *	for a AES_CMAC or a AES_GMAC key to indicate that it requires sequence
2345  *	number generation only
2346  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SPP_AMSDU: SPP A-MSDUs can be used with this key
2347  *	(set by mac80211 from the sta->spp_amsdu flag)
2348  */
2349 enum ieee80211_key_flags {
2350 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT	= BIT(0),
2351 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV		= BIT(1),
2352 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC	= BIT(2),
2353 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE		= BIT(3),
2354 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX		= BIT(4),
2355 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE		= BIT(5),
2356 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT		= BIT(6),
2357 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM	= BIT(7),
2358 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE	= BIT(8),
2359 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX		= BIT(9),
2360 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE	= BIT(10),
2361 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SPP_AMSDU		= BIT(11),
2362 };
2363 
2364 /**
2365  * struct ieee80211_key_conf - key information
2366  *
2367  * This key information is given by mac80211 to the driver by
2368  * the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops.
2369  *
2370  * @hw_key_idx: To be set by the driver, this is the key index the driver
2371  *	wants to be given when a frame is transmitted and needs to be
2372  *	encrypted in hardware.
2373  * @cipher: The key's cipher suite selector.
2374  * @tx_pn: PN used for TX keys, may be used by the driver as well if it
2375  *	needs to do software PN assignment by itself (e.g. due to TSO)
2376  * @flags: key flags, see &enum ieee80211_key_flags.
2377  * @keyidx: the key index (0-7)
2378  * @keylen: key material length
2379  * @key: key material. For ALG_TKIP the key is encoded as a 256-bit (32 byte)
2380  * 	data block:
2381  * 	- Temporal Encryption Key (128 bits)
2382  * 	- Temporal Authenticator Tx MIC Key (64 bits)
2383  * 	- Temporal Authenticator Rx MIC Key (64 bits)
2384  * @icv_len: The ICV length for this key type
2385  * @iv_len: The IV length for this key type
2386  * @link_id: the link ID, 0 for non-MLO, or -1 for pairwise keys
2387  */
2388 struct ieee80211_key_conf {
2389 	atomic64_t tx_pn;
2390 	u32 cipher;
2391 	u8 icv_len;
2392 	u8 iv_len;
2393 	u8 hw_key_idx;
2394 	s8 keyidx;
2395 	u16 flags;
2396 	s8 link_id;
2397 	u8 keylen;
2398 	u8 key[];
2399 };
2400 
2401 #define IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN	16
2402 
2403 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV16(pn) ((u16)(pn & 0xffff))
2404 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV32(pn) ((u32)((pn >> 16) & 0xffffffff))
2405 
2406 /**
2407  * struct ieee80211_key_seq - key sequence counter
2408  *
2409  * @tkip: TKIP data, containing IV32 and IV16 in host byte order
2410  * @ccmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2411  *	reverse order than in packet)
2412  * @aes_cmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2413  *	reverse order than in packet)
2414  * @aes_gmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2415  *	reverse order than in packet)
2416  * @gcmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2417  *	reverse order than in packet)
2418  * @hw: data for HW-only (e.g. cipher scheme) keys
2419  */
2420 struct ieee80211_key_seq {
2421 	union {
2422 		struct {
2423 			u32 iv32;
2424 			u16 iv16;
2425 		} tkip;
2426 		struct {
2427 			u8 pn[6];
2428 		} ccmp;
2429 		struct {
2430 			u8 pn[6];
2431 		} aes_cmac;
2432 		struct {
2433 			u8 pn[6];
2434 		} aes_gmac;
2435 		struct {
2436 			u8 pn[6];
2437 		} gcmp;
2438 		struct {
2439 			u8 seq[IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN];
2440 			u8 seq_len;
2441 		} hw;
2442 	};
2443 };
2444 
2445 /**
2446  * enum set_key_cmd - key command
2447  *
2448  * Used with the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2449  * indicates whether a key is being removed or added.
2450  *
2451  * @SET_KEY: a key is set
2452  * @DISABLE_KEY: a key must be disabled
2453  */
2454 enum set_key_cmd {
2455 	SET_KEY, DISABLE_KEY,
2456 };
2457 
2458 /**
2459  * enum ieee80211_sta_state - station state
2460  *
2461  * @IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST: station doesn't exist at all,
2462  *	this is a special state for add/remove transitions
2463  * @IEEE80211_STA_NONE: station exists without special state
2464  * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTH: station is authenticated
2465  * @IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC: station is associated
2466  * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X)
2467  */
2468 enum ieee80211_sta_state {
2469 	/* NOTE: These need to be ordered correctly! */
2470 	IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST,
2471 	IEEE80211_STA_NONE,
2472 	IEEE80211_STA_AUTH,
2473 	IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC,
2474 	IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED,
2475 };
2476 
2477 /**
2478  * enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth - station RX bandwidth
2479  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20: station can only receive 20 MHz
2480  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40: station can receive up to 40 MHz
2481  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80: station can receive up to 80 MHz
2482  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160: station can receive up to 160 MHz
2483  *	(including 80+80 MHz)
2484  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320: station can receive up to 320 MHz
2485  *
2486  * Implementation note: 20 must be zero to be initialized
2487  *	correctly, the values must be sorted.
2488  */
2489 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth {
2490 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20 = 0,
2491 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40,
2492 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80,
2493 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160,
2494 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320,
2495 };
2496 
2497 #define IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_MAX	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320
2498 
2499 /**
2500  * struct ieee80211_sta_rates - station rate selection table
2501  *
2502  * @rcu_head: RCU head used for freeing the table on update
2503  * @rate: transmit rates/flags to be used by default.
2504  *	Overriding entries per-packet is possible by using cb tx control.
2505  */
2506 struct ieee80211_sta_rates {
2507 	struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2508 	struct {
2509 		s8 idx;
2510 		u8 count;
2511 		u8 count_cts;
2512 		u8 count_rts;
2513 		u16 flags;
2514 	} rate[IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE];
2515 };
2516 
2517 /**
2518  * struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration
2519  *
2520  * Used to configure txpower for station.
2521  *
2522  * @power: indicates the tx power, in dBm, to be used when sending data frames
2523  *	to the STA.
2524  * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power
2525  *	will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC
2526  *	%type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power.
2527  *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for
2528  *	per peer TPC.
2529  */
2530 struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr {
2531 	s16 power;
2532 	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type;
2533 };
2534 
2535 /**
2536  * struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates - info that is aggregated from active links
2537  *
2538  * Used for any per-link data that needs to be aggregated and updated in the
2539  * main &struct ieee80211_sta when updated or the active links change.
2540  *
2541  * @max_amsdu_len: indicates the maximal length of an A-MSDU in bytes.
2542  *	This field is always valid for packets with a VHT preamble.
2543  *	For packets with a HT preamble, additional limits apply:
2544  *
2545  *	* If the skb is transmitted as part of a BA agreement, the
2546  *	  A-MSDU maximal size is min(max_amsdu_len, 4065) bytes.
2547  *	* If the skb is not part of a BA agreement, the A-MSDU maximal
2548  *	  size is min(max_amsdu_len, 7935) bytes.
2549  *
2550  * Both additional HT limits must be enforced by the low level
2551  * driver. This is defined by the spec (IEEE 802.11-2012 section
2552  * 8.3.2.2 NOTE 2).
2553  * @max_rc_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes recommended by rate control.
2554  * @max_tid_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes for this TID
2555  */
2556 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates {
2557 	u16 max_amsdu_len;
2558 
2559 	u16 max_rc_amsdu_len;
2560 	u16 max_tid_amsdu_len[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS];
2561 };
2562 
2563 /**
2564  * struct ieee80211_link_sta - station Link specific info
2565  * All link specific info for a STA link for a non MLD STA(single)
2566  * or a MLD STA(multiple entries) are stored here.
2567  *
2568  * @sta: reference to owning STA
2569  * @addr: MAC address of the Link STA. For non-MLO STA this is same as the addr
2570  *	in ieee80211_sta. For MLO Link STA this addr can be same or different
2571  *	from addr in ieee80211_sta (representing MLD STA addr)
2572  * @link_id: the link ID for this link STA (0 for deflink)
2573  * @smps_mode: current SMPS mode (off, static or dynamic)
2574  * @supp_rates: Bitmap of supported rates
2575  * @ht_cap: HT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2576  * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2577  * @he_cap: HE capabilities of this STA
2578  * @he_6ghz_capa: on 6 GHz, holds the HE 6 GHz band capabilities
2579  * @eht_cap: EHT capabilities of this STA
2580  * @uhr_cap: UHR capabilities of this STA
2581  * @s1g_cap: S1G capabilities of this STA
2582  * @agg: per-link data for multi-link aggregation
2583  * @bandwidth: current bandwidth the station can receive with.
2584  *	This is the minimum between the peer's capabilities and our own
2585  *	operating channel width; Invalid for NAN since that is operating on
2586  *	multiple channels.
2587  * @rx_nss: in HT/VHT, the maximum number of spatial streams the
2588  *	station can receive at the moment, changed by operating mode
2589  *	notifications and capabilities. The value is only valid after
2590  *	the station moves to associated state. Invalid for NAN since it
2591  *	operates on multiple configurations of rx_nss.
2592  * @txpwr: the station tx power configuration
2593  *
2594  */
2595 struct ieee80211_link_sta {
2596 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2597 
2598 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
2599 	u8 link_id;
2600 	enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
2601 
2602 	u32 supp_rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2603 	struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
2604 	struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap;
2605 	struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap;
2606 	struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa;
2607 	struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap eht_cap;
2608 	struct ieee80211_sta_uhr_cap uhr_cap;
2609 	struct ieee80211_sta_s1g_cap s1g_cap;
2610 
2611 	struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates agg;
2612 
2613 	u8 rx_nss;
2614 	enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth bandwidth;
2615 	struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr txpwr;
2616 };
2617 
2618 /**
2619  * struct ieee80211_sta - station table entry
2620  *
2621  * A station table entry represents a station we are possibly
2622  * communicating with. Since stations are RCU-managed in
2623  * mac80211, any ieee80211_sta pointer you get access to must
2624  * either be protected by rcu_read_lock() explicitly or implicitly,
2625  * or you must take good care to not use such a pointer after a
2626  * call to your sta_remove callback that removed it.
2627  * This also represents the MLD STA in case of MLO association
2628  * and holds pointers to various link STA's
2629  *
2630  * @addr: MAC address
2631  * @aid: AID we assigned to the station if we're an AP
2632  * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximal amount of frames in a single AMPDU
2633  *	that this station is allowed to transmit to us.
2634  *	Can be modified by driver.
2635  * @wme: indicates whether the STA supports QoS/WME (if local devices does,
2636  *	otherwise always false)
2637  * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
2638  *	sizeof(void \*), size is determined in hw information.
2639  * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Only valid
2640  *	if wme is supported. The bits order is like in
2641  *	IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_*.
2642  * @max_sp: max Service Period. Only valid if wme is supported.
2643  * @rates: rate control selection table
2644  * @tdls: indicates whether the STA is a TDLS peer
2645  * @tdls_initiator: indicates the STA is an initiator of the TDLS link. Only
2646  *	valid if the STA is a TDLS peer in the first place.
2647  * @mfp: indicates whether the STA uses management frame protection or not.
2648  * @mlo: indicates whether the STA is MLO station.
2649  * @max_amsdu_subframes: indicates the maximal number of MSDUs in a single
2650  *	A-MSDU. Taken from the Extended Capabilities element. 0 means
2651  *	unlimited.
2652  * @eml_cap: EML capabilities of this MLO station
2653  * @cur: currently valid data as aggregated from the active links
2654  *	For non MLO STA it will point to the deflink data. For MLO STA
2655  *	ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates() must be called to update it.
2656  * @support_p2p_ps: indicates whether the STA supports P2P PS mechanism or not.
2657  * @txq: per-TID data TX queues; note that the last entry (%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS)
2658  *	is used for non-data frames
2659  * @deflink: This holds the default link STA information, for non MLO STA all link
2660  *	specific STA information is accessed through @deflink or through
2661  *	link[0] which points to address of @deflink. For MLO Link STA
2662  *	the first added link STA will point to deflink.
2663  * @link: reference to Link Sta entries. For Non MLO STA, except 1st link,
2664  *	i.e link[0] all links would be assigned to NULL by default and
2665  *	would access link information via @deflink or link[0]. For MLO
2666  *	STA, first link STA being added will point its link pointer to
2667  *	@deflink address and remaining would be allocated and the address
2668  *	would be assigned to link[link_id] where link_id is the id assigned
2669  *	by the AP.
2670  * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO
2671  * @spp_amsdu: indicates whether the STA uses SPP A-MSDU or not.
2672  * @epp_peer: indicates that the peer is an EPP peer.
2673  * @nmi: For NDI stations, pointer to the NMI station of the peer.
2674  * @nan_sched: NAN peer schedule for this station. Valid only for NMI stations.
2675  */
2676 struct ieee80211_sta {
2677 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
2678 	u16 aid;
2679 	u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
2680 	bool wme;
2681 	u8 uapsd_queues;
2682 	u8 max_sp;
2683 	struct ieee80211_sta_rates __rcu *rates;
2684 	bool tdls;
2685 	bool tdls_initiator;
2686 	bool mfp;
2687 	bool mlo;
2688 	bool spp_amsdu;
2689 	u8 max_amsdu_subframes;
2690 	u16 eml_cap;
2691 
2692 	struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates *cur;
2693 
2694 	bool support_p2p_ps;
2695 
2696 	struct ieee80211_txq *txq[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS + 1];
2697 
2698 	u16 valid_links;
2699 	bool epp_peer;
2700 	struct ieee80211_link_sta deflink;
2701 	struct ieee80211_link_sta __rcu *link[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
2702 
2703 	struct ieee80211_sta __rcu *nmi;
2704 
2705 	/* should only be accessed with the wiphy mutex held */
2706 	struct ieee80211_nan_peer_sched *nan_sched;
2707 
2708 	/* must be last */
2709 	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2710 };
2711 
2712 #ifdef CONFIG_LOCKDEP
2713 bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
2714 #else
2715 static inline bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta)
2716 {
2717 	return true;
2718 }
2719 #endif
2720 
2721 #define link_sta_dereference_protected(sta, link_id)		\
2722 	rcu_dereference_protected((sta)->link[link_id],		\
2723 				  lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))
2724 
2725 #define link_sta_dereference_check(sta, link_id)		\
2726 	rcu_dereference_check((sta)->link[link_id],		\
2727 			      lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))
2728 
2729 #define for_each_sta_active_link(vif, sta, link_sta, link_id)			\
2730 	for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((sta)->link); link_id++)		\
2731 		if ((!(vif)->active_links ||					\
2732 		     (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) &&			\
2733 		    ((link_sta) = link_sta_dereference_check(sta, link_id)))
2734 
2735 /**
2736  * enum sta_notify_cmd - sta notify command
2737  *
2738  * Used with the sta_notify() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2739  * indicates if an associated station made a power state transition.
2740  *
2741  * @STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP: a station is now sleeping
2742  * @STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE: a sleeping station woke up
2743  */
2744 enum sta_notify_cmd {
2745 	STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP, STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE,
2746 };
2747 
2748 /**
2749  * struct ieee80211_tx_control - TX control data
2750  *
2751  * @sta: station table entry, this sta pointer may be NULL and
2752  * 	it is not allowed to copy the pointer, due to RCU.
2753  */
2754 struct ieee80211_tx_control {
2755 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2756 };
2757 
2758 /**
2759  * struct ieee80211_txq - Software intermediate tx queue
2760  *
2761  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
2762  * @sta: station table entry, %NULL for per-vif queue
2763  * @tid: the TID for this queue (unused for per-vif queue),
2764  *	%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS for non-data (if enabled)
2765  * @ac: the AC for this queue
2766  * @drv_priv: driver private area, sized by hw->txq_data_size
2767  *
2768  * The driver can obtain packets from this queue by calling
2769  * ieee80211_tx_dequeue().
2770  */
2771 struct ieee80211_txq {
2772 	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
2773 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2774 	u8 tid;
2775 	u8 ac;
2776 
2777 	/* must be last */
2778 	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2779 };
2780 
2781 /**
2782  * enum ieee80211_hw_flags - hardware flags
2783  *
2784  * These flags are used to indicate hardware capabilities to
2785  * the stack. Generally, flags here should have their meaning
2786  * done in a way that the simplest hardware doesn't need setting
2787  * any particular flags. There are some exceptions to this rule,
2788  * however, so you are advised to review these flags carefully.
2789  *
2790  * @IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL:
2791  *	The hardware or firmware includes rate control, and cannot be
2792  *	controlled by the stack. As such, no rate control algorithm
2793  *	should be instantiated, and the TX rate reported to userspace
2794  *	will be taken from the TX status instead of the rate control
2795  *	algorithm.
2796  *	Note that this requires that the driver implement a number of
2797  *	callbacks so it has the correct information, it needs to have
2798  *	the @set_rts_threshold callback and must look at the BSS config
2799  *	@use_cts_prot for G/N protection, @use_short_slot for slot
2800  *	timing in 2.4 GHz and @use_short_preamble for preambles for
2801  *	CCK frames.
2802  *
2803  * @IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS:
2804  *	Indicates that received frames passed to the stack include
2805  *	the FCS at the end.
2806  *
2807  * @IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING:
2808  *	Some wireless LAN chipsets buffer broadcast/multicast frames
2809  *	for power saving stations in the hardware/firmware and others
2810  *	rely on the host system for such buffering. This option is used
2811  *	to configure the IEEE 802.11 upper layer to buffer broadcast and
2812  *	multicast frames when there are power saving stations so that
2813  *	the driver can fetch them with ieee80211_get_buffered_bc().
2814  *
2815  * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC:
2816  *	Hardware can provide signal values but we don't know its units. We
2817  *	expect values between 0 and @max_signal.
2818  *	If possible please provide dB or dBm instead.
2819  *
2820  * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM:
2821  *	Hardware gives signal values in dBm, decibel difference from
2822  *	one milliwatt. This is the preferred method since it is standardized
2823  *	between different devices. @max_signal does not need to be set.
2824  *
2825  * @IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT:
2826  * 	Hardware supports spectrum management defined in 802.11h
2827  * 	Measurement, Channel Switch, Quieting, TPC
2828  *
2829  * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION:
2830  *	Hardware supports 11n A-MPDU aggregation.
2831  *
2832  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS:
2833  *	Hardware has power save support (i.e. can go to sleep).
2834  *
2835  * @IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK:
2836  *	Hardware requires nullfunc frame handling in stack, implies
2837  *	stack support for dynamic PS.
2838  *
2839  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS:
2840  *	Hardware has support for dynamic PS.
2841  *
2842  * @IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE:
2843  *	Hardware supports management frame protection (MFP, IEEE 802.11w).
2844  *
2845  * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS:
2846  *	Hardware can provide ack status reports of Tx frames to
2847  *	the stack.
2848  *
2849  * @IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR:
2850  *	The hardware performs its own connection monitoring, including
2851  *	periodic keep-alives to the AP and probing the AP on beacon loss.
2852  *
2853  * @IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC:
2854  *	This device needs to get data from beacon before association (i.e.
2855  *	dtim_period).
2856  *
2857  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK: The device's crypto engine supports
2858  *	per-station GTKs as used by IBSS RSN or during fast transition. If
2859  *	the device doesn't support per-station GTKs, but can be asked not
2860  *	to decrypt group addressed frames, then IBSS RSN support is still
2861  *	possible but software crypto will be used. Advertise the wiphy flag
2862  *	only in that case.
2863  *
2864  * @IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS: When operating in AP mode the device
2865  *	autonomously manages the PS status of connected stations. When
2866  *	this flag is set mac80211 will not trigger PS mode for connected
2867  *	stations based on the PM bit of incoming frames.
2868  *	Use ieee80211_start_ps()/ieee8021_end_ps() to manually configure
2869  *	the PS mode of connected stations.
2870  *
2871  * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW: The device handles TX A-MPDU session
2872  *	setup strictly in HW. mac80211 should not attempt to do this in
2873  *	software.
2874  *
2875  * @IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF: The driver would like to be informed of
2876  *	a virtual monitor interface when monitor interfaces are the only
2877  *	active interfaces.
2878  *
2879  * @IEEE80211_HW_NO_VIRTUAL_MONITOR: The driver would like to be informed
2880  *	of any monitor interface, as well as their configured channel.
2881  *	This is useful for supporting multiple monitor interfaces on different
2882  *	channels.
2883  *
2884  * @IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF: The driver would like for no wlanX to
2885  *	be created.  It is expected user-space will create vifs as
2886  *	desired (and thus have them named as desired).
2887  *
2888  * @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL: The driver wants to control which of the
2889  *	crypto algorithms can be done in software - so don't automatically
2890  *	try to fall back to it if hardware crypto fails, but do so only if
2891  *	the driver returns 1. This also forces the driver to advertise its
2892  *	supported cipher suites.
2893  *
2894  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT: The driver/hardware supports fast-xmit,
2895  *	this currently requires only the ability to calculate the duration
2896  *	for frames.
2897  *
2898  * @IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL: The driver wants to control per-interface
2899  *	queue mapping in order to use different queues (not just one per AC)
2900  *	for different virtual interfaces. See the doc section on HW queue
2901  *	control for more details.
2902  *
2903  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE: The driver supports using a rate
2904  *	selection table provided by the rate control algorithm.
2905  *
2906  * @IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF: Use the P2P Device address for any
2907  *	P2P Interface. This will be honoured even if more than one interface
2908  *	is supported.
2909  *
2910  * @IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY: Use sync timing from beacon frames
2911  *	only, to allow getting TBTT of a DTIM beacon.
2912  *
2913  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES: Hardware supports mixing HT/CCK rates
2914  *	and can cope with CCK rates in an aggregation session (e.g. by not
2915  *	using aggregation for such frames.)
2916  *
2917  * @IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA: Support 802.11h based channel-switch (CSA)
2918  *	for a single active channel while using channel contexts. When support
2919  *	is not enabled the default action is to disconnect when getting the
2920  *	CSA frame.
2921  *
2922  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS: The driver will never modify the payload
2923  *	or tailroom of TX skbs without copying them first.
2924  *
2925  * @IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS: The HW supports scanning on all bands
2926  *	in one command, mac80211 doesn't have to run separate scans per band.
2927  *
2928  * @IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW: The device/driver supports wider bandwidth
2929  *	than then BSS bandwidth for a TDLS link on the base channel.
2930  *
2931  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU: The driver supports receiving A-MSDUs
2932  *	within A-MPDU.
2933  *
2934  * @IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS: The device/driver provides TX status
2935  *	for sent beacons.
2936  *
2937  * @IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR: Hardware (or driver) requires that each
2938  *	station has a unique address, i.e. each station entry can be identified
2939  *	by just its MAC address; this prevents, for example, the same station
2940  *	from connecting to two virtual AP interfaces at the same time.
2941  *	Note that this doesn't apply for NAN, in which the peer's NMI address
2942  *	can be equal to its NDI address.
2943  *
2944  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER: Hardware (or driver) manages the
2945  *	reordering buffer internally, guaranteeing mac80211 receives frames in
2946  *	order and does not need to manage its own reorder buffer or BA session
2947  *	timeout.
2948  *
2949  * @IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS: The device uses RSS and thus requires parallel RX,
2950  *	which implies using per-CPU station statistics.
2951  *
2952  * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU: Hardware (or driver) supports software aggregated
2953  *	A-MSDU frames. Requires software tx queueing and fast-xmit support.
2954  *	When not using minstrel/minstrel_ht rate control, the driver must
2955  *	limit the maximum A-MSDU size based on the current tx rate by setting
2956  *	max_rc_amsdu_len in struct ieee80211_sta.
2957  *
2958  * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST: Hardware (or driver) supports sending frag_list
2959  *	skbs, needed for zero-copy software A-MSDU.
2960  *
2961  * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK: The driver (or firmware) reports low ack event
2962  *	by ieee80211_report_low_ack() based on its own algorithm. For such
2963  *	drivers, mac80211 packet loss mechanism will not be triggered and driver
2964  *	is completely depending on firmware event for station kickout.
2965  *
2966  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG: Hardware does fragmentation by itself.
2967  *	The stack will not do fragmentation.
2968  *	The callback for @set_frag_threshold should be set as well.
2969  *
2970  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA: Hardware supports buffer STA on
2971  *	TDLS links.
2972  *
2973  * @IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP: The driver (or firmware) doesn't
2974  *	support QoS NDP for AP probing - that's most likely a driver bug.
2975  *
2976  * @IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ: use the TXQ for bufferable MMPDUs, this of
2977  *	course requires the driver to use TXQs to start with.
2978  *
2979  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW: (Hardware) rate control supports VHT
2980  *	extended NSS BW (dot11VHTExtendedNSSBWCapable). This flag will be set if
2981  *	the selected rate control algorithm sets %RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW
2982  *	but if the rate control is built-in then it must be set by the driver.
2983  *	See also the documentation for that flag.
2984  *
2985  * @IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ: use the extra non-TID per-station TXQ for all
2986  *	MMPDUs on station interfaces. This of course requires the driver to use
2987  *	TXQs to start with.
2988  *
2989  * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN: Driver does not report accurate A-MPDU
2990  *	length in tx status information
2991  *
2992  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2993  *
2994  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2995  *	only for HE APs. Applies if @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID is set.
2996  *
2997  * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT: The card and driver is only
2998  *	aggregating MPDUs with the same keyid, allowing mac80211 to keep Tx
2999  *	A-MPDU sessions active while rekeying with Extended Key ID.
3000  *
3001  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports tx encapsulation
3002  *	offload
3003  *
3004  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports rx decapsulation
3005  *	offload
3006  *
3007  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP: Hardware supports concurrent rx
3008  *	decapsulation offload and passing raw 802.11 frames for monitor iface.
3009  *	If this is supported, the driver must pass both 802.3 frames for real
3010  *	usage and 802.11 frames with %RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR set for monitor to
3011  *	the stack.
3012  *
3013  * @IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION: HW/driver has support for BSS color
3014  *	collision detection and doesn't need it in software.
3015  *
3016  * @IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX: Hardware/driver handles transmitting
3017  *	multicast frames on all links, mac80211 should not do that.
3018  *
3019  * @IEEE80211_HW_DISALLOW_PUNCTURING: HW requires disabling puncturing in EHT
3020  *	and connecting with a lower bandwidth instead
3021  *
3022  * @IEEE80211_HW_HANDLES_QUIET_CSA: HW/driver handles quieting for CSA, so
3023  *	no need to stop queues. This really should be set by a driver that
3024  *	implements MLO, so operation can continue on other links when one
3025  *	link is switching.
3026  *
3027  * @IEEE80211_HW_STRICT: strictly enforce certain things mandated by the spec
3028  *	but otherwise ignored/worked around for interoperability. This is a
3029  *	HW flag so drivers can opt in according to their own control, e.g. in
3030  *	testing.
3031  *
3032  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_NDP_BLOCKACK: HW can transmit/receive S1G NDP
3033  *	BlockAck frames.
3034  *
3035  * @NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS: number of hardware flags, used for sizing arrays
3036  */
3037 enum ieee80211_hw_flags {
3038 	IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL,
3039 	IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS,
3040 	IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING,
3041 	IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC,
3042 	IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM,
3043 	IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC,
3044 	IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT,
3045 	IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION,
3046 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS,
3047 	IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK,
3048 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS,
3049 	IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE,
3050 	IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF,
3051 	IEEE80211_HW_NO_VIRTUAL_MONITOR,
3052 	IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF,
3053 	IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL,
3054 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT,
3055 	IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS,
3056 	IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR,
3057 	IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL,
3058 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK,
3059 	IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS,
3060 	IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW,
3061 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE,
3062 	IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF,
3063 	IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY,
3064 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES,
3065 	IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA,
3066 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS,
3067 	IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS,
3068 	IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW,
3069 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU,
3070 	IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS,
3071 	IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR,
3072 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER,
3073 	IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS,
3074 	IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU,
3075 	IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST,
3076 	IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK,
3077 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG,
3078 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA,
3079 	IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP,
3080 	IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ,
3081 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW,
3082 	IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ,
3083 	IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN,
3084 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID,
3085 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID,
3086 	IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT,
3087 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD,
3088 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD,
3089 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP,
3090 	IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION,
3091 	IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX,
3092 	IEEE80211_HW_DISALLOW_PUNCTURING,
3093 	IEEE80211_HW_HANDLES_QUIET_CSA,
3094 	IEEE80211_HW_STRICT,
3095 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_NDP_BLOCKACK,
3096 
3097 	/* keep last, obviously */
3098 	NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS
3099 };
3100 
3101 /**
3102  * struct ieee80211_hw - hardware information and state
3103  *
3104  * This structure contains the configuration and hardware
3105  * information for an 802.11 PHY.
3106  *
3107  * @wiphy: This points to the &struct wiphy allocated for this
3108  *	802.11 PHY. You must fill in the @perm_addr and @dev
3109  *	members of this structure using SET_IEEE80211_DEV()
3110  *	and SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(). Additionally, all supported
3111  *	bands (with channels, bitrates) are registered here.
3112  *
3113  * @conf: &struct ieee80211_conf, device configuration, don't use.
3114  *
3115  * @priv: pointer to private area that was allocated for driver use
3116  *	along with this structure.
3117  *
3118  * @flags: hardware flags, see &enum ieee80211_hw_flags.
3119  *
3120  * @extra_tx_headroom: headroom to reserve in each transmit skb
3121  *	for use by the driver (e.g. for transmit headers.)
3122  *
3123  * @extra_beacon_tailroom: tailroom to reserve in each beacon tx skb.
3124  *	Can be used by drivers to add extra IEs.
3125  *
3126  * @max_signal: Maximum value for signal (rssi) in RX information, used
3127  *	only when @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC or @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DB
3128  *
3129  * @max_listen_interval: max listen interval in units of beacon interval
3130  *	that HW supports
3131  *
3132  * @queues: number of available hardware transmit queues for
3133  *	data packets. WMM/QoS requires at least four, these
3134  *	queues need to have configurable access parameters.
3135  *
3136  * @rate_control_algorithm: rate control algorithm for this hardware.
3137  *	If unset (NULL), the default algorithm will be used. Must be
3138  *	set before calling ieee80211_register_hw().
3139  *
3140  * @vif_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
3141  *	within &struct ieee80211_vif.
3142  * @sta_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
3143  *	within &struct ieee80211_sta.
3144  * @chanctx_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
3145  *	within &struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf.
3146  * @txq_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
3147  *	within @struct ieee80211_txq.
3148  *
3149  * @max_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages the hw
3150  *	can handle.
3151  * @max_report_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages
3152  *	the hw can report back.
3153  * @max_rate_tries: maximum number of tries for each stage
3154  *
3155  * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximum buffer size (number of
3156  *	sub-frames) to be used for A-MPDU block ack receiver
3157  *	aggregation.
3158  *	This is only relevant if the device has restrictions on the
3159  *	number of subframes, if it relies on mac80211 to do reordering
3160  *	it shouldn't be set.
3161  *
3162  * @max_tx_aggregation_subframes: maximum number of subframes in an
3163  *	aggregate an HT/HE device will transmit. In HT AddBA we'll
3164  *	advertise a constant value of 64 as some older APs crash if
3165  *	the window size is smaller (an example is LinkSys WRT120N
3166  *	with FW v1.0.07 build 002 Jun 18 2012).
3167  *	For AddBA to HE capable peers this value will be used.
3168  *
3169  * @max_tx_fragments: maximum number of tx buffers per (A)-MSDU, sum
3170  *	of 1 + skb_shinfo(skb)->nr_frags for each skb in the frag_list.
3171  *
3172  * @offchannel_tx_hw_queue: HW queue ID to use for offchannel TX
3173  *	(if %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL is set)
3174  *
3175  * @radiotap_mcs_details: lists which MCS information can the HW
3176  *	reports, by default it is set to _MCS, _GI and _BW but doesn't
3177  *	include _FMT. Use %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_\* values, only
3178  *	adding _BW is supported today.
3179  *
3180  * @radiotap_vht_details: lists which VHT MCS information the HW reports,
3181  *	the default is _GI | _BANDWIDTH.
3182  *	Use the %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_VHT_KNOWN_\* values.
3183  *
3184  * @radiotap_timestamp: Information for the radiotap timestamp field; if the
3185  *	@units_pos member is set to a non-negative value then the timestamp
3186  *	field will be added and populated from the &struct ieee80211_rx_status
3187  *	device_timestamp.
3188  * @radiotap_timestamp.units_pos: Must be set to a combination of a
3189  *	IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_UNIT_* and a
3190  *	IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_SPOS_* value.
3191  * @radiotap_timestamp.accuracy: If non-negative, fills the accuracy in the
3192  *	radiotap field and the accuracy known flag will be set.
3193  *
3194  * @netdev_features: netdev features to be set in each netdev created
3195  *	from this HW. Note that not all features are usable with mac80211,
3196  *	other features will be rejected during HW registration.
3197  *
3198  * @uapsd_queues: This bitmap is included in (re)association frame to indicate
3199  *	for each access category if it is uAPSD trigger-enabled and delivery-
3200  *	enabled. Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_* to set this bitmap.
3201  *	Each bit corresponds to different AC. Value '1' in specific bit means
3202  *	that corresponding AC is both trigger- and delivery-enabled. '0' means
3203  *	neither enabled.
3204  *
3205  * @uapsd_max_sp_len: maximum number of total buffered frames the WMM AP may
3206  *	deliver to a WMM STA during any Service Period triggered by the WMM STA.
3207  *	Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_SP_* for correct values.
3208  *
3209  * @max_nan_de_entries: maximum number of NAN DE functions supported by the
3210  *	device.
3211  *
3212  * @tx_sk_pacing_shift: Pacing shift to set on TCP sockets when frames from
3213  *	them are encountered. The default should typically not be changed,
3214  *	unless the driver has good reasons for needing more buffers.
3215  *
3216  * @weight_multiplier: Driver specific airtime weight multiplier used while
3217  *	refilling deficit of each TXQ.
3218  *
3219  * @max_mtu: the max mtu could be set.
3220  *
3221  * @tx_power_levels: a list of power levels supported by the wifi hardware.
3222  * 	The power levels can be specified either as integer or fractions.
3223  * 	The power level at idx 0 shall be the maximum positive power level.
3224  *
3225  * @max_txpwr_levels_idx: the maximum valid idx of 'tx_power_levels' list.
3226  */
3227 struct ieee80211_hw {
3228 	struct ieee80211_conf conf;
3229 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
3230 	const char *rate_control_algorithm;
3231 	void *priv;
3232 	unsigned long flags[BITS_TO_LONGS(NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS)];
3233 	unsigned int extra_tx_headroom;
3234 	unsigned int extra_beacon_tailroom;
3235 	int vif_data_size;
3236 	int sta_data_size;
3237 	int chanctx_data_size;
3238 	int txq_data_size;
3239 	u16 queues;
3240 	u16 max_listen_interval;
3241 	s8 max_signal;
3242 	u8 max_rates;
3243 	u8 max_report_rates;
3244 	u8 max_rate_tries;
3245 	u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
3246 	u16 max_tx_aggregation_subframes;
3247 	u8 max_tx_fragments;
3248 	u8 offchannel_tx_hw_queue;
3249 	u8 radiotap_mcs_details;
3250 	u16 radiotap_vht_details;
3251 	struct {
3252 		int units_pos;
3253 		s16 accuracy;
3254 	} radiotap_timestamp;
3255 	netdev_features_t netdev_features;
3256 	u8 uapsd_queues;
3257 	u8 uapsd_max_sp_len;
3258 	u8 max_nan_de_entries;
3259 	u8 tx_sk_pacing_shift;
3260 	u8 weight_multiplier;
3261 	u32 max_mtu;
3262 	const s8 *tx_power_levels;
3263 	u8 max_txpwr_levels_idx;
3264 };
3265 
3266 static inline bool _ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3267 				       enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
3268 {
3269 	return test_bit(flg, hw->flags);
3270 }
3271 #define ieee80211_hw_check(hw, flg)	_ieee80211_hw_check(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
3272 
3273 static inline void _ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3274 				     enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
3275 {
3276 	return __set_bit(flg, hw->flags);
3277 }
3278 #define ieee80211_hw_set(hw, flg)	_ieee80211_hw_set(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
3279 
3280 /**
3281  * struct ieee80211_scan_request - hw scan request
3282  *
3283  * @ies: pointers different parts of IEs (in req.ie)
3284  * @req: cfg80211 request.
3285  */
3286 struct ieee80211_scan_request {
3287 	struct ieee80211_scan_ies ies;
3288 
3289 	/* Keep last */
3290 	struct cfg80211_scan_request req;
3291 };
3292 
3293 /**
3294  * struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params - TDLS channel switch parameters
3295  *
3296  * @sta: peer this TDLS channel-switch request/response came from
3297  * @chandef: channel referenced in a TDLS channel-switch request
3298  * @action_code: see &enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode
3299  * @status: channel-switch response status
3300  * @timestamp: time at which the frame was received
3301  * @switch_time: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
3302  * @switch_timeout: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
3303  * @tmpl_skb: TDLS switch-channel response template
3304  * @ch_sw_tm_ie: offset of the channel-switch timing IE inside @tmpl_skb
3305  */
3306 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params {
3307 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
3308 	struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef;
3309 	u8 action_code;
3310 	u32 status;
3311 	u32 timestamp;
3312 	u16 switch_time;
3313 	u16 switch_timeout;
3314 	struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb;
3315 	u32 ch_sw_tm_ie;
3316 };
3317 
3318 /**
3319  * wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw - return a mac80211 driver hw struct from a wiphy
3320  *
3321  * @wiphy: the &struct wiphy which we want to query
3322  *
3323  * mac80211 drivers can use this to get to their respective
3324  * &struct ieee80211_hw. Drivers wishing to get to their own private
3325  * structure can then access it via hw->priv. Note that mac802111 drivers should
3326  * not use wiphy_priv() to try to get their private driver structure as this
3327  * is already used internally by mac80211.
3328  *
3329  * Return: The mac80211 driver hw struct of @wiphy.
3330  */
3331 struct ieee80211_hw *wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw(struct wiphy *wiphy);
3332 
3333 /**
3334  * SET_IEEE80211_DEV - set device for 802.11 hardware
3335  *
3336  * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the device for
3337  * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
3338  */
3339 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct device *dev)
3340 {
3341 	set_wiphy_dev(hw->wiphy, dev);
3342 }
3343 
3344 /**
3345  * SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR - set the permanent MAC address for 802.11 hardware
3346  *
3347  * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the MAC address for
3348  * @addr: the address to set
3349  */
3350 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, const u8 *addr)
3351 {
3352 	memcpy(hw->wiphy->perm_addr, addr, ETH_ALEN);
3353 }
3354 
3355 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
3356 ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3357 		      const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
3358 {
3359 	if (WARN_ON_ONCE(c->control.rates[0].idx < 0))
3360 		return NULL;
3361 
3362 	if (c->band >= NUM_NL80211_BANDS)
3363 		return NULL;
3364 
3365 	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[0].idx];
3366 }
3367 
3368 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
3369 ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3370 			   const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
3371 {
3372 	if (c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx < 0)
3373 		return NULL;
3374 	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx];
3375 }
3376 
3377 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
3378 ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3379 			     const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c, int idx)
3380 {
3381 	if (c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx < 0)
3382 		return NULL;
3383 	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx];
3384 }
3385 
3386 /**
3387  * ieee80211_free_txskb - free TX skb
3388  * @hw: the hardware
3389  * @skb: the skb
3390  *
3391  * Free a transmit skb. Use this function when some failure
3392  * to transmit happened and thus status cannot be reported.
3393  */
3394 void ieee80211_free_txskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
3395 
3396 /**
3397  * ieee80211_purge_tx_queue - purge TX skb queue
3398  * @hw: the hardware
3399  * @skbs: the skbs
3400  *
3401  * Free a set of transmit skbs. Use this function when device is going to stop
3402  * but some transmit skbs without TX status are still queued.
3403  * This function does not take the list lock and the caller must hold the
3404  * relevant locks to use it.
3405  */
3406 void ieee80211_purge_tx_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3407 			      struct sk_buff_head *skbs);
3408 
3409 /**
3410  * DOC: Hardware crypto acceleration
3411  *
3412  * mac80211 is capable of taking advantage of many hardware
3413  * acceleration designs for encryption and decryption operations.
3414  *
3415  * The set_key() callback in the &struct ieee80211_ops for a given
3416  * device is called to enable hardware acceleration of encryption and
3417  * decryption. The callback takes a @sta parameter that will be NULL
3418  * for default keys or keys used for transmission only, or point to
3419  * the station information for the peer for individual keys.
3420  * Multiple transmission keys with the same key index may be used when
3421  * VLANs are configured for an access point.
3422  *
3423  * When transmitting, the TX control data will use the @hw_key_idx
3424  * selected by the driver by modifying the &struct ieee80211_key_conf
3425  * pointed to by the @key parameter to the set_key() function.
3426  *
3427  * The set_key() call for the %SET_KEY command should return 0 if
3428  * the key is now in use, -%EOPNOTSUPP or -%ENOSPC if it couldn't be
3429  * added; if you return 0 then hw_key_idx must be assigned to the
3430  * hardware key index. You are free to use the full u8 range.
3431  *
3432  * Note that in the case that the @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL flag is
3433  * set, mac80211 will not automatically fall back to software crypto if
3434  * enabling hardware crypto failed. The set_key() call may also return the
3435  * value 1 to permit this specific key/algorithm to be done in software.
3436  *
3437  * When the cmd is %DISABLE_KEY then it must succeed.
3438  *
3439  * Note that it is permissible to not decrypt a frame even if a key
3440  * for it has been uploaded to hardware. The stack will not make any
3441  * decision based on whether a key has been uploaded or not but rather
3442  * based on the receive flags.
3443  *
3444  * The &struct ieee80211_key_conf structure pointed to by the @key
3445  * parameter is guaranteed to be valid until another call to set_key()
3446  * removes it, but it can only be used as a cookie to differentiate
3447  * keys.
3448  *
3449  * In TKIP some HW need to be provided a phase 1 key, for RX decryption
3450  * acceleration (i.e. iwlwifi). Those drivers should provide update_tkip_key
3451  * handler.
3452  * The update_tkip_key() call updates the driver with the new phase 1 key.
3453  * This happens every time the iv16 wraps around (every 65536 packets). The
3454  * set_key() call will happen only once for each key (unless the AP did
3455  * rekeying); it will not include a valid phase 1 key. The valid phase 1 key is
3456  * provided by update_tkip_key only. The trigger that makes mac80211 call this
3457  * handler is software decryption with wrap around of iv16.
3458  *
3459  * The set_default_unicast_key() call updates the default WEP key index
3460  * configured to the hardware for WEP encryption type. This is required
3461  * for devices that support offload of data packets (e.g. ARP responses).
3462  *
3463  * Mac80211 drivers should set the @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0 flag
3464  * when they are able to replace in-use PTK keys according to the following
3465  * requirements:
3466  * 1) They do not hand over frames decrypted with the old key to mac80211
3467       once the call to set_key() with command %DISABLE_KEY has been completed,
3468    2) either drop or continue to use the old key for any outgoing frames queued
3469       at the time of the key deletion (including re-transmits),
3470    3) never send out a frame queued prior to the set_key() %SET_KEY command
3471       encrypted with the new key when also needing
3472       @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV and
3473    4) never send out a frame unencrypted when it should be encrypted.
3474    Mac80211 will not queue any new frames for a deleted key to the driver.
3475  */
3476 
3477 /**
3478  * DOC: Powersave support
3479  *
3480  * mac80211 has support for various powersave implementations.
3481  *
3482  * First, it can support hardware that handles all powersaving by itself;
3483  * such hardware should simply set the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS hardware
3484  * flag. In that case, it will be told about the desired powersave mode
3485  * with the %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag depending on the association status.
3486  * The hardware must take care of sending nullfunc frames when necessary,
3487  * i.e. when entering and leaving powersave mode. The hardware is required
3488  * to look at the AID in beacons and signal to the AP that it woke up when
3489  * it finds traffic directed to it.
3490  *
3491  * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag enabled means that the powersave mode defined in
3492  * IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2 is enabled. This is not to be confused
3493  * with hardware wakeup and sleep states. Driver is responsible for waking
3494  * up the hardware before issuing commands to the hardware and putting it
3495  * back to sleep at appropriate times.
3496  *
3497  * When PS is enabled, hardware needs to wakeup for beacons and receive the
3498  * buffered multicast/broadcast frames after the beacon. Also it must be
3499  * possible to send frames and receive the acknowledment frame.
3500  *
3501  * Other hardware designs cannot send nullfunc frames by themselves and also
3502  * need software support for parsing the TIM bitmap. This is also supported
3503  * by mac80211 by combining the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS and
3504  * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK flags. The hardware is of course still
3505  * required to pass up beacons. The hardware is still required to handle
3506  * waking up for multicast traffic; if it cannot the driver must handle that
3507  * as best as it can; mac80211 is too slow to do that.
3508  *
3509  * Dynamic powersave is an extension to normal powersave in which the
3510  * hardware stays awake for a user-specified period of time after sending a
3511  * frame so that reply frames need not be buffered and therefore delayed to
3512  * the next wakeup. It's a compromise of getting good enough latency when
3513  * there's data traffic and still saving significantly power in idle
3514  * periods.
3515  *
3516  * Dynamic powersave is simply supported by mac80211 enabling and disabling
3517  * PS based on traffic. Driver needs to only set %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS
3518  * flag and mac80211 will handle everything automatically. Additionally,
3519  * hardware having support for the dynamic PS feature may set the
3520  * %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS flag to indicate that it can support
3521  * dynamic PS mode itself. The driver needs to look at the
3522  * @dynamic_ps_timeout hardware configuration value and use it that value
3523  * whenever %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. In this case mac80211 will disable
3524  * dynamic PS feature in stack and will just keep %IEEE80211_CONF_PS
3525  * enabled whenever user has enabled powersave.
3526  *
3527  * Driver informs U-APSD client support by enabling
3528  * %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD flag. The mode is configured through the
3529  * uapsd parameter in conf_tx() operation. Hardware needs to send the QoS
3530  * Nullfunc frames and stay awake until the service period has ended. To
3531  * utilize U-APSD, dynamic powersave is disabled for voip AC and all frames
3532  * from that AC are transmitted with powersave enabled.
3533  *
3534  * Note: U-APSD client mode is not yet supported with
3535  * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK.
3536  */
3537 
3538 /**
3539  * DOC: Beacon filter support
3540  *
3541  * Some hardware have beacon filter support to reduce host cpu wakeups
3542  * which will reduce system power consumption. It usually works so that
3543  * the firmware creates a checksum of the beacon but omits all constantly
3544  * changing elements (TSF, TIM etc). Whenever the checksum changes the
3545  * beacon is forwarded to the host, otherwise it will be just dropped. That
3546  * way the host will only receive beacons where some relevant information
3547  * (for example ERP protection or WMM settings) have changed.
3548  *
3549  * Beacon filter support is advertised with the %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER
3550  * interface capability. The driver needs to enable beacon filter support
3551  * whenever power save is enabled, that is %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. When
3552  * power save is enabled, the stack will not check for beacon loss and the
3553  * driver needs to notify about loss of beacons with ieee80211_beacon_loss().
3554  *
3555  * The time (or number of beacons missed) until the firmware notifies the
3556  * driver of a beacon loss event (which in turn causes the driver to call
3557  * ieee80211_beacon_loss()) should be configurable and will be controlled
3558  * by mac80211 and the roaming algorithm in the future.
3559  *
3560  * Since there may be constantly changing information elements that nothing
3561  * in the software stack cares about, we will, in the future, have mac80211
3562  * tell the driver which information elements are interesting in the sense
3563  * that we want to see changes in them. This will include
3564  *
3565  *  - a list of information element IDs
3566  *  - a list of OUIs for the vendor information element
3567  *
3568  * Ideally, the hardware would filter out any beacons without changes in the
3569  * requested elements, but if it cannot support that it may, at the expense
3570  * of some efficiency, filter out only a subset. For example, if the device
3571  * doesn't support checking for OUIs it should pass up all changes in all
3572  * vendor information elements.
3573  *
3574  * Note that change, for the sake of simplification, also includes information
3575  * elements appearing or disappearing from the beacon.
3576  *
3577  * Some hardware supports an "ignore list" instead. Just make sure nothing
3578  * that was requested is on the ignore list, and include commonly changing
3579  * information element IDs in the ignore list, for example 11 (BSS load) and
3580  * the various vendor-assigned IEs with unknown contents (128, 129, 133-136,
3581  * 149, 150, 155, 156, 173, 176, 178, 179, 219); for forward compatibility
3582  * it could also include some currently unused IDs.
3583  *
3584  *
3585  * In addition to these capabilities, hardware should support notifying the
3586  * host of changes in the beacon RSSI. This is relevant to implement roaming
3587  * when no traffic is flowing (when traffic is flowing we see the RSSI of
3588  * the received data packets). This can consist of notifying the host when
3589  * the RSSI changes significantly or when it drops below or rises above
3590  * configurable thresholds. In the future these thresholds will also be
3591  * configured by mac80211 (which gets them from userspace) to implement
3592  * them as the roaming algorithm requires.
3593  *
3594  * If the hardware cannot implement this, the driver should ask it to
3595  * periodically pass beacon frames to the host so that software can do the
3596  * signal strength threshold checking.
3597  */
3598 
3599 /**
3600  * DOC: Spatial multiplexing power save
3601  *
3602  * SMPS (Spatial multiplexing power save) is a mechanism to conserve
3603  * power in an 802.11n implementation. For details on the mechanism
3604  * and rationale, please refer to 802.11 (as amended by 802.11n-2009)
3605  * "11.2.3 SM power save".
3606  *
3607  * The mac80211 implementation is capable of sending action frames
3608  * to update the AP about the station's SMPS mode, and will instruct
3609  * the driver to enter the specific mode. It will also announce the
3610  * requested SMPS mode during the association handshake. Hardware
3611  * support for this feature is required, and can be indicated by
3612  * hardware flags.
3613  *
3614  * The default mode will be "automatic", which nl80211/cfg80211
3615  * defines to be dynamic SMPS in (regular) powersave, and SMPS
3616  * turned off otherwise.
3617  *
3618  * To support this feature, the driver must set the appropriate
3619  * hardware support flags, and handle the SMPS flag to the config()
3620  * operation. It will then with this mechanism be instructed to
3621  * enter the requested SMPS mode while associated to an HT AP.
3622  */
3623 
3624 /**
3625  * DOC: Frame filtering
3626  *
3627  * mac80211 requires to see many management frames for proper
3628  * operation, and users may want to see many more frames when
3629  * in monitor mode. However, for best CPU usage and power consumption,
3630  * having as few frames as possible percolate through the stack is
3631  * desirable. Hence, the hardware should filter as much as possible.
3632  *
3633  * To achieve this, mac80211 uses filter flags (see below) to tell
3634  * the driver's configure_filter() function which frames should be
3635  * passed to mac80211 and which should be filtered out.
3636  *
3637  * Before configure_filter() is invoked, the prepare_multicast()
3638  * callback is invoked with the parameters @mc_count and @mc_list
3639  * for the combined multicast address list of all virtual interfaces.
3640  * It's use is optional, and it returns a u64 that is passed to
3641  * configure_filter(). Additionally, configure_filter() has the
3642  * arguments @changed_flags telling which flags were changed and
3643  * @total_flags with the new flag states.
3644  *
3645  * If your device has no multicast address filters your driver will
3646  * need to check both the %FIF_ALLMULTI flag and the @mc_count
3647  * parameter to see whether multicast frames should be accepted
3648  * or dropped.
3649  *
3650  * All unsupported flags in @total_flags must be cleared.
3651  * Hardware does not support a flag if it is incapable of _passing_
3652  * the frame to the stack. Otherwise the driver must ignore
3653  * the flag, but not clear it.
3654  * You must _only_ clear the flag (announce no support for the
3655  * flag to mac80211) if you are not able to pass the packet type
3656  * to the stack (so the hardware always filters it).
3657  * So for example, you should clear @FIF_CONTROL, if your hardware
3658  * always filters control frames. If your hardware always passes
3659  * control frames to the kernel and is incapable of filtering them,
3660  * you do _not_ clear the @FIF_CONTROL flag.
3661  * This rule applies to all other FIF flags as well.
3662  */
3663 
3664 /**
3665  * DOC: AP support for powersaving clients
3666  *
3667  * In order to implement AP and P2P GO modes, mac80211 has support for
3668  * client powersaving, both "legacy" PS (PS-Poll/null data) and uAPSD.
3669  * There currently is no support for sAPSD.
3670  *
3671  * There is one assumption that mac80211 makes, namely that a client
3672  * will not poll with PS-Poll and trigger with uAPSD at the same time.
3673  * Both are supported, and both can be used by the same client, but
3674  * they can't be used concurrently by the same client. This simplifies
3675  * the driver code.
3676  *
3677  * The first thing to keep in mind is that there is a flag for complete
3678  * driver implementation: %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS. If this flag is set,
3679  * mac80211 expects the driver to handle most of the state machine for
3680  * powersaving clients and will ignore the PM bit in incoming frames.
3681  * Drivers then use ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() to inform mac80211 of
3682  * stations' powersave transitions. In this mode, mac80211 also doesn't
3683  * handle PS-Poll/uAPSD.
3684  *
3685  * In the mode without %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS, mac80211 will check the
3686  * PM bit in incoming frames for client powersave transitions. When a
3687  * station goes to sleep, we will stop transmitting to it. There is,
3688  * however, a race condition: a station might go to sleep while there is
3689  * data buffered on hardware queues. If the device has support for this
3690  * it will reject frames, and the driver should give the frames back to
3691  * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED flag set which will
3692  * cause mac80211 to retry the frame when the station wakes up. The
3693  * driver is also notified of powersave transitions by calling its
3694  * @sta_notify callback.
3695  *
3696  * When the station is asleep, it has three choices: it can wake up,
3697  * it can PS-Poll, or it can possibly start a uAPSD service period.
3698  * Waking up is implemented by simply transmitting all buffered (and
3699  * filtered) frames to the station. This is the easiest case. When
3700  * the station sends a PS-Poll or a uAPSD trigger frame, mac80211
3701  * will inform the driver of this with the @allow_buffered_frames
3702  * callback; this callback is optional. mac80211 will then transmit
3703  * the frames as usual and set the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER
3704  * on each frame. The last frame in the service period (or the only
3705  * response to a PS-Poll) also has %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set to
3706  * indicate that it ends the service period; as this frame must have
3707  * TX status report it also sets %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS.
3708  * When TX status is reported for this frame, the service period is
3709  * marked has having ended and a new one can be started by the peer.
3710  *
3711  * Additionally, non-bufferable MMPDUs can also be transmitted by
3712  * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER set in them.
3713  *
3714  * Another race condition can happen on some devices like iwlwifi
3715  * when there are frames queued for the station and it wakes up
3716  * or polls; the frames that are already queued could end up being
3717  * transmitted first instead, causing reordering and/or wrong
3718  * processing of the EOSP. The cause is that allowing frames to be
3719  * transmitted to a certain station is out-of-band communication to
3720  * the device. To allow this problem to be solved, the driver can
3721  * call ieee80211_sta_block_awake() if frames are buffered when it
3722  * is notified that the station went to sleep. When all these frames
3723  * have been filtered (see above), it must call the function again
3724  * to indicate that the station is no longer blocked.
3725  *
3726  * If the driver buffers frames in the driver for aggregation in any
3727  * way, it must use the ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() call when it is
3728  * notified of the station going to sleep to inform mac80211 of any
3729  * TIDs that have frames buffered. Note that when a station wakes up
3730  * this information is reset (hence the requirement to call it when
3731  * informed of the station going to sleep). Then, when a service
3732  * period starts for any reason, @release_buffered_frames is called
3733  * with the number of frames to be released and which TIDs they are
3734  * to come from. In this case, the driver is responsible for setting
3735  * the EOSP (for uAPSD) and MORE_DATA bits in the released frames.
3736  * To help the @more_data parameter is passed to tell the driver if
3737  * there is more data on other TIDs -- the TIDs to release frames
3738  * from are ignored since mac80211 doesn't know how many frames the
3739  * buffers for those TIDs contain.
3740  *
3741  * If the driver also implement GO mode, where absence periods may
3742  * shorten service periods (or abort PS-Poll responses), it must
3743  * filter those response frames except in the case of frames that
3744  * are buffered in the driver -- those must remain buffered to avoid
3745  * reordering. Because it is possible that no frames are released
3746  * in this case, the driver must call ieee80211_sta_eosp()
3747  * to indicate to mac80211 that the service period ended anyway.
3748  *
3749  * Finally, if frames from multiple TIDs are released from mac80211
3750  * but the driver might reorder them, it must clear & set the flags
3751  * appropriately (only the last frame may have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
3752  * and also take care of the EOSP and MORE_DATA bits in the frame.
3753  * The driver may also use ieee80211_sta_eosp() in this case.
3754  *
3755  * Note that if the driver ever buffers frames other than QoS-data
3756  * frames, it must take care to never send a non-QoS-data frame as
3757  * the last frame in a service period, adding a QoS-nulldata frame
3758  * after a non-QoS-data frame if needed.
3759  */
3760 
3761 /**
3762  * DOC: HW queue control
3763  *
3764  * Before HW queue control was introduced, mac80211 only had a single static
3765  * assignment of per-interface AC software queues to hardware queues. This
3766  * was problematic for a few reasons:
3767  * 1) off-channel transmissions might get stuck behind other frames
3768  * 2) multiple virtual interfaces couldn't be handled correctly
3769  * 3) after-DTIM frames could get stuck behind other frames
3770  *
3771  * To solve this, hardware typically uses multiple different queues for all
3772  * the different usages, and this needs to be propagated into mac80211 so it
3773  * won't have the same problem with the software queues.
3774  *
3775  * Therefore, mac80211 now offers the %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL capability
3776  * flag that tells it that the driver implements its own queue control. To do
3777  * so, the driver will set up the various queues in each &struct ieee80211_vif
3778  * and the offchannel queue in &struct ieee80211_hw. In response, mac80211 will
3779  * use those queue IDs in the hw_queue field of &struct ieee80211_tx_info and
3780  * if necessary will queue the frame on the right software queue that mirrors
3781  * the hardware queue.
3782  * Additionally, the driver has to then use these HW queue IDs for the queue
3783  * management functions (ieee80211_stop_queue() et al.)
3784  *
3785  * The driver is free to set up the queue mappings as needed; multiple virtual
3786  * interfaces may map to the same hardware queues if needed. The setup has to
3787  * happen during add_interface or change_interface callbacks. For example, a
3788  * driver supporting station+station and station+AP modes might decide to have
3789  * 10 hardware queues to handle different scenarios:
3790  *
3791  * 4 AC HW queues for 1st vif: 0, 1, 2, 3
3792  * 4 AC HW queues for 2nd vif: 4, 5, 6, 7
3793  * after-DTIM queue for AP:   8
3794  * off-channel queue:         9
3795  *
3796  * It would then set up the hardware like this:
3797  *   hw.offchannel_tx_hw_queue = 9
3798  *
3799  * and the first virtual interface that is added as follows:
3800  *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VO] = 0
3801  *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VI] = 1
3802  *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BE] = 2
3803  *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BK] = 3
3804  *   vif.cab_queue = 8 // if AP mode, otherwise %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3805  * and the second virtual interface with 4-7.
3806  *
3807  * If queue 6 gets full, for example, mac80211 would only stop the second
3808  * virtual interface's BE queue since virtual interface queues are per AC.
3809  *
3810  * Note that the vif.cab_queue value should be set to %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3811  * whenever the queue is not used (i.e. the interface is not in AP mode) if the
3812  * queue could potentially be shared since mac80211 will look at cab_queue when
3813  * a queue is stopped/woken even if the interface is not in AP mode.
3814  */
3815 
3816 /**
3817  * enum ieee80211_filter_flags - hardware filter flags
3818  *
3819  * These flags determine what the filter in hardware should be
3820  * programmed to let through and what should not be passed to the
3821  * stack. It is always safe to pass more frames than requested,
3822  * but this has negative impact on power consumption.
3823  *
3824  * @FIF_ALLMULTI: pass all multicast frames, this is used if requested
3825  *	by the user or if the hardware is not capable of filtering by
3826  *	multicast address.
3827  *
3828  * @FIF_FCSFAIL: pass frames with failed FCS (but you need to set the
3829  *	%RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC for them)
3830  *
3831  * @FIF_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with failed PLCP CRC (but you need to set
3832  *	the %RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC for them
3833  *
3834  * @FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC: This flag is set during scanning to indicate
3835  *	to the hardware that it should not filter beacons or probe responses
3836  *	by BSSID. Filtering them can greatly reduce the amount of processing
3837  *	mac80211 needs to do and the amount of CPU wakeups, so you should
3838  *	honour this flag if possible.
3839  *
3840  * @FIF_CONTROL: pass control frames (except for PS Poll) addressed to this
3841  *	station
3842  *
3843  * @FIF_OTHER_BSS: pass frames destined to other BSSes
3844  *
3845  * @FIF_PSPOLL: pass PS Poll frames
3846  *
3847  * @FIF_PROBE_REQ: pass probe request frames
3848  *
3849  * @FIF_MCAST_ACTION: pass multicast Action frames
3850  */
3851 enum ieee80211_filter_flags {
3852 	FIF_ALLMULTI		= 1<<1,
3853 	FIF_FCSFAIL		= 1<<2,
3854 	FIF_PLCPFAIL		= 1<<3,
3855 	FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC	= 1<<4,
3856 	FIF_CONTROL		= 1<<5,
3857 	FIF_OTHER_BSS		= 1<<6,
3858 	FIF_PSPOLL		= 1<<7,
3859 	FIF_PROBE_REQ		= 1<<8,
3860 	FIF_MCAST_ACTION	= 1<<9,
3861 };
3862 
3863 /**
3864  * enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action - A-MPDU actions
3865  *
3866  * These flags are used with the ampdu_action() callback in
3867  * &struct ieee80211_ops to indicate which action is needed.
3868  *
3869  * Note that drivers MUST be able to deal with a TX aggregation
3870  * session being stopped even before they OK'ed starting it by
3871  * calling ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe, because the peer
3872  * might receive the addBA frame and send a delBA right away!
3873  *
3874  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START: start RX aggregation
3875  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP: stop RX aggregation
3876  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START: start TX aggregation, the driver must either
3877  *	call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() or
3878  *	call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() with status
3879  *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA to delay addba after
3880  *	ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe is called, or just return the special
3881  *	status %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE.
3882  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL: TX aggregation has become operational
3883  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT: stop TX aggregation but continue transmitting
3884  *	queued packets, now unaggregated. After all packets are transmitted the
3885  *	driver has to call ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe().
3886  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH: stop TX aggregation and flush all packets,
3887  *	called when the station is removed. There's no need or reason to call
3888  *	ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() in this case as mac80211 assumes the
3889  *	session is gone and removes the station.
3890  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT: called when TX aggregation is stopped
3891  *	but the driver hasn't called ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() yet and
3892  *	now the connection is dropped and the station will be removed. Drivers
3893  *	should clean up and drop remaining packets when this is called.
3894  */
3895 enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action {
3896 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START,
3897 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP,
3898 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START,
3899 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT,
3900 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH,
3901 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT,
3902 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL,
3903 };
3904 
3905 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE 1
3906 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA 2
3907 
3908 /**
3909  * struct ieee80211_ampdu_params - AMPDU action parameters
3910  *
3911  * @action: the ampdu action, value from %ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
3912  * @sta: peer of this AMPDU session
3913  * @tid: tid of the BA session
3914  * @ssn: start sequence number of the session. TX/RX_STOP can pass 0. When
3915  *	action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START the driver passes back the
3916  *	actual ssn value used to start the session and writes the value here.
3917  * @buf_size: reorder buffer size  (number of subframes). Valid only when the
3918  *	action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START or
3919  *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3920  * @amsdu: indicates the peer's ability to receive A-MSDU within A-MPDU.
3921  *	valid when the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3922  * @timeout: BA session timeout. Valid only when the action is set to
3923  *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START
3924  */
3925 struct ieee80211_ampdu_params {
3926 	enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action action;
3927 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
3928 	u16 tid;
3929 	u16 ssn;
3930 	u16 buf_size;
3931 	bool amsdu;
3932 	u16 timeout;
3933 };
3934 
3935 /**
3936  * enum ieee80211_frame_release_type - frame release reason
3937  * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL: frame released for PS-Poll
3938  * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD: frame(s) released due to
3939  *	frame received on trigger-enabled AC
3940  */
3941 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type {
3942 	IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL,
3943 	IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD,
3944 };
3945 
3946 /**
3947  * enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed - flags to indicate what changed
3948  *
3949  * @IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED: The bandwidth that can be used to transmit
3950  *	to this station changed. The actual bandwidth is in the station
3951  *	information -- for HT20/40 the IEEE80211_HT_CAP_SUP_WIDTH_20_40
3952  *	flag changes, for HT and VHT the bandwidth field changes.
3953  * @IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED: The SMPS state of the station changed.
3954  * @IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED: The supported rate set of this peer
3955  *	changed (in IBSS mode) due to discovering more information about
3956  *	the peer.
3957  * @IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED: N_SS (number of spatial streams) was changed
3958  *	by the peer
3959  */
3960 enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed {
3961 	IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED		= BIT(0),
3962 	IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED	= BIT(1),
3963 	IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED	= BIT(2),
3964 	IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED	= BIT(3),
3965 };
3966 
3967 /**
3968  * enum ieee80211_roc_type - remain on channel type
3969  *
3970  * With the support for multi channel contexts and multi channel operations,
3971  * remain on channel operations might be limited/deferred/aborted by other
3972  * flows/operations which have higher priority (and vice versa).
3973  * Specifying the ROC type can be used by devices to prioritize the ROC
3974  * operations compared to other operations/flows.
3975  *
3976  * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL: There are no special requirements for this ROC.
3977  * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX: The remain on channel request is required
3978  *	for sending management frames offchannel.
3979  */
3980 enum ieee80211_roc_type {
3981 	IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL = 0,
3982 	IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX,
3983 };
3984 
3985 /**
3986  * enum ieee80211_reconfig_type - reconfig type
3987  *
3988  * This enum is used by the reconfig_complete() callback to indicate what
3989  * reconfiguration type was completed.
3990  *
3991  * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART: hw restart type
3992  *	(also due to resume() callback returning 1)
3993  * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND: suspend type (regardless
3994  *	of wowlan configuration)
3995  */
3996 enum ieee80211_reconfig_type {
3997 	IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART,
3998 	IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND,
3999 };
4000 
4001 /**
4002  * struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info - prepare TX information
4003  * @duration: if non-zero, hint about the required duration,
4004  *	only used with the mgd_prepare_tx() method.
4005  * @subtype: frame subtype (auth, (re)assoc, deauth, disassoc)
4006  * @success: whether the frame exchange was successful, only
4007  *	used with the mgd_complete_tx() method, and then only
4008  *	valid for auth and (re)assoc.
4009  * @was_assoc: set if this call is due to deauth/disassoc
4010  *	while just having been associated
4011  * @link_id: the link id on which the frame will be TX'ed.
4012  *	0 for a non-MLO connection.
4013  */
4014 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info {
4015 	u16 duration;
4016 	u16 subtype;
4017 	u8 success:1, was_assoc:1;
4018 	int link_id;
4019 };
4020 
4021 /**
4022  * struct ieee80211_ops - callbacks from mac80211 to the driver
4023  *
4024  * This structure contains various callbacks that the driver may
4025  * handle or, in some cases, must handle, for example to configure
4026  * the hardware to a new channel or to transmit a frame.
4027  *
4028  * @tx: Handler that 802.11 module calls for each transmitted frame.
4029  *	skb contains the buffer starting from the IEEE 802.11 header.
4030  *	The low-level driver should send the frame out based on
4031  *	configuration in the TX control data. This handler should,
4032  *	preferably, never fail and stop queues appropriately.
4033  *	Must be atomic.
4034  *
4035  * @start: Called before the first netdevice attached to the hardware
4036  *	is enabled. This should turn on the hardware and must turn on
4037  *	frame reception (for possibly enabled monitor interfaces.)
4038  *	Returns negative error codes, these may be seen in userspace,
4039  *	or zero.
4040  *	When the device is started it should not have a MAC address
4041  *	to avoid acknowledging frames before a non-monitor device
4042  *	is added.
4043  *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
4044  *
4045  * @stop: Called after last netdevice attached to the hardware
4046  *	is disabled. This should turn off the hardware (at least
4047  *	it must turn off frame reception.)
4048  *	May be called right after add_interface if that rejects
4049  *	an interface. If you added any work onto the mac80211 workqueue
4050  *	you should ensure to cancel it on this callback.
4051  *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
4052  *
4053  * @suspend: Suspend the device; mac80211 itself will quiesce before and
4054  *	stop transmitting and doing any other configuration, and then
4055  *	ask the device to suspend. This is only invoked when WoWLAN is
4056  *	configured, otherwise the device is deconfigured completely and
4057  *	reconfigured at resume time.
4058  *	The driver may also impose special conditions under which it
4059  *	wants to use the "normal" suspend (deconfigure), say if it only
4060  *	supports WoWLAN when the device is associated. In this case, it
4061  *	must return 1 from this function.
4062  *
4063  * @resume: If WoWLAN was configured, this indicates that mac80211 is
4064  *	now resuming its operation, after this the device must be fully
4065  *	functional again. If this returns an error, the only way out is
4066  *	to also unregister the device. If it returns 1, then mac80211
4067  *	will also go through the regular complete restart on resume.
4068  *
4069  * @set_wakeup: Enable or disable wakeup when WoWLAN configuration is
4070  *	modified. The reason is that device_set_wakeup_enable() is
4071  *	supposed to be called when the configuration changes, not only
4072  *	in suspend().
4073  *
4074  * @add_interface: Called when a netdevice attached to the hardware is
4075  *	enabled. Because it is not called for monitor mode devices, @start
4076  *	and @stop must be implemented.
4077  *	The driver should perform any initialization it needs before
4078  *	the device can be enabled. The initial configuration for the
4079  *	interface is given in the conf parameter.
4080  *	The callback may refuse to add an interface by returning a
4081  *	negative error code (which will be seen in userspace.)
4082  *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
4083  *
4084  * @change_interface: Called when a netdevice changes type. This callback
4085  *	is optional, but only if it is supported can interface types be
4086  *	switched while the interface is UP. The callback may sleep.
4087  *	Note that while an interface is being switched, it will not be
4088  *	found by the interface iteration callbacks.
4089  *
4090  * @remove_interface: Notifies a driver that an interface is going down.
4091  *	The @stop callback is called after this if it is the last interface
4092  *	and no monitor interfaces are present.
4093  *	When all interfaces are removed, the MAC address in the hardware
4094  *	must be cleared so the device no longer acknowledges packets,
4095  *	the mac_addr member of the conf structure is, however, set to the
4096  *	MAC address of the device going away.
4097  *	Hence, this callback must be implemented. It can sleep.
4098  *
4099  * @config: Handler for configuration requests. IEEE 802.11 code calls this
4100  *	function to change hardware configuration, e.g., channel.
4101  *	This function should never fail but returns a negative error code
4102  *	if it does. The callback can sleep.
4103  *
4104  * @bss_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to BSS
4105  *	parameters that may vary during BSS's lifespan, and may affect low
4106  *	level driver (e.g. assoc/disassoc status, erp parameters).
4107  *	This function should not be used if no BSS has been set, unless
4108  *	for association indication. The @changed parameter indicates which
4109  *	of the bss parameters has changed when a call is made. The callback
4110  *	can sleep.
4111  *	Note: this callback is called if @vif_cfg_changed or @link_info_changed
4112  *	are not implemented.
4113  *
4114  * @vif_cfg_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to interface
4115  *	(MLD) parameters from &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg that vary during the
4116  *	lifetime of the interface (e.g. assoc status, IP addresses, etc.)
4117  *	The @changed parameter indicates which value changed.
4118  *	The callback can sleep.
4119  *
4120  * @link_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to link
4121  *	parameters from &struct ieee80211_bss_conf that are related to an
4122  *	individual link. e.g. legacy/HT/VHT/... rate information.
4123  *	The @changed parameter indicates which value changed, and the @link_id
4124  *	parameter indicates the link ID. Note that the @link_id will be 0 for
4125  *	non-MLO connections.
4126  *	The callback can sleep.
4127  *
4128  * @prepare_multicast: Prepare for multicast filter configuration.
4129  *	This callback is optional, and its return value is passed
4130  *	to configure_filter(). This callback must be atomic.
4131  *
4132  * @configure_filter: Configure the device's RX filter.
4133  *	See the section "Frame filtering" for more information.
4134  *	This callback must be implemented and can sleep.
4135  *
4136  * @config_iface_filter: Configure the interface's RX filter.
4137  *	This callback is optional and is used to configure which frames
4138  *	should be passed to mac80211. The filter_flags is the combination
4139  *	of FIF_* flags. The changed_flags is a bit mask that indicates
4140  *	which flags are changed.
4141  *	This callback can sleep.
4142  *
4143  * @set_tim: Set TIM bit. mac80211 calls this function when a TIM bit
4144  * 	must be set or cleared for a given STA. Must be atomic.
4145  *
4146  * @set_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
4147  *	This callback is only called between add_interface and
4148  *	remove_interface calls, i.e. while the given virtual interface
4149  *	is enabled.
4150  *	Returns a negative error code if the key can't be added.
4151  *	The callback can sleep.
4152  *
4153  * @update_tkip_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
4154  * 	This callback will be called in the context of Rx. Called for drivers
4155  * 	which set IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_TKIP_REQ_RX_P1_KEY.
4156  *	The callback must be atomic.
4157  *
4158  * @set_rekey_data: If the device supports GTK rekeying, for example while the
4159  *	host is suspended, it can assign this callback to retrieve the data
4160  *	necessary to do GTK rekeying, this is the KEK, KCK and replay counter.
4161  *	After rekeying was done it should (for example during resume) notify
4162  *	userspace of the new replay counter using ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify().
4163  *
4164  * @set_default_unicast_key: Set the default (unicast) key index, useful for
4165  *	WEP when the device sends data packets autonomously, e.g. for ARP
4166  *	offloading. The index can be 0-3, or -1 for unsetting it.
4167  *
4168  * @hw_scan: Ask the hardware to service the scan request, no need to start
4169  *	the scan state machine in stack. The scan must honour the channel
4170  *	configuration done by the regulatory agent in the wiphy's
4171  *	registered bands. The hardware (or the driver) needs to make sure
4172  *	that power save is disabled.
4173  *	The @req ie/ie_len members are rewritten by mac80211 to contain the
4174  *	entire IEs after the SSID, so that drivers need not look at these
4175  *	at all but just send them after the SSID -- mac80211 includes the
4176  *	(extended) supported rates and HT information (where applicable).
4177  *	When the scan finishes, ieee80211_scan_completed() must be called;
4178  *	note that it also must be called when the scan cannot finish due to
4179  *	any error unless this callback returned a negative error code.
4180  *	This callback is also allowed to return the special return value 1,
4181  *	this indicates that hardware scan isn't desirable right now and a
4182  *	software scan should be done instead. A driver wishing to use this
4183  *	capability must ensure its (hardware) scan capabilities aren't
4184  *	advertised as more capable than mac80211's software scan is.
4185  *	The callback can sleep.
4186  *
4187  * @cancel_hw_scan: Ask the low-level tp cancel the active hw scan.
4188  *	The driver should ask the hardware to cancel the scan (if possible),
4189  *	but the scan will be completed only after the driver will call
4190  *	ieee80211_scan_completed().
4191  *	This callback is needed for wowlan, to prevent enqueueing a new
4192  *	scan_work after the low-level driver was already suspended.
4193  *	The callback can sleep.
4194  *
4195  * @sched_scan_start: Ask the hardware to start scanning repeatedly at
4196  *	specific intervals.  The driver must call the
4197  *	ieee80211_sched_scan_results() function whenever it finds results.
4198  *	This process will continue until sched_scan_stop is called.
4199  *
4200  * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the hardware to stop an ongoing scheduled scan.
4201  *	In this case, ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped() must not be called.
4202  *
4203  * @sw_scan_start: Notifier function that is called just before a software scan
4204  *	is started. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need this notification.
4205  *	The mac_addr parameter allows supporting NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR,
4206  *	the driver may set the NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR flag if it
4207  *	can use this parameter. The callback can sleep.
4208  *
4209  * @sw_scan_complete: Notifier function that is called just after a
4210  *	software scan finished. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need
4211  *	this notification.
4212  *	The callback can sleep.
4213  *
4214  * @get_stats: Return low-level statistics.
4215  * 	Returns zero if statistics are available.
4216  *	The callback can sleep.
4217  *
4218  * @get_key_seq: If your device implements encryption in hardware and does
4219  *	IV/PN assignment then this callback should be provided to read the
4220  *	IV/PN for the given key from hardware.
4221  *	The callback must be atomic.
4222  *
4223  * @set_frag_threshold: Configuration of fragmentation threshold. Assign this
4224  *	if the device does fragmentation by itself. Note that to prevent the
4225  *	stack from doing fragmentation IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG
4226  *	should be set as well.
4227  *	The callback can sleep.
4228  *
4229  * @set_rts_threshold: Configuration of RTS threshold (if device needs it)
4230  *	The callback can sleep.
4231  *
4232  * @sta_add: Notifies low level driver about addition of an associated station,
4233  *	AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. This callback can sleep.
4234  *
4235  * @sta_remove: Notifies low level driver about removal of an associated
4236  *	station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. Note that after the callback
4237  *	returns it isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected;
4238  *	no RCU grace period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing
4239  *	the station. See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
4240  *	This callback can sleep.
4241  *
4242  * @vif_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add a debugfs vif
4243  *	directory with its files. This callback should be within a
4244  *	CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This callback can sleep.
4245  *
4246  * @link_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
4247  *	when a link is added to a mac80211 vif. This callback should be within
4248  *	a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This callback can sleep.
4249  *	For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the default bss_conf
4250  *	with the vif's directory rather than a separate subdirectory.
4251  *
4252  * @sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
4253  *	when a station is added to mac80211's station list. This callback
4254  *	should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
4255  *	callback can sleep.
4256  *
4257  * @link_sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
4258  *	when a link is added to a mac80211 station. This callback
4259  *	should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
4260  *	callback can sleep.
4261  *	For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the deflink with the
4262  *	station's directory rather than a separate subdirectory.
4263  *
4264  * @sta_notify: Notifies low level driver about power state transition of an
4265  *	associated station, AP,  IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. For a VIF operating
4266  *	in AP mode, this callback will not be called when the flag
4267  *	%IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS is set. Must be atomic.
4268  *
4269  * @sta_set_txpwr: Configure the station tx power. This callback set the tx
4270  *	power for the station.
4271  *	This callback can sleep.
4272  *
4273  * @sta_state: Notifies low level driver about state transition of a
4274  *	station (which can be the AP, a client, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc.)
4275  *	This callback is mutually exclusive with @sta_add/@sta_remove.
4276  *	It must not fail for down transitions but may fail for transitions
4277  *	up the list of states. Also note that after the callback returns it
4278  *	isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected - no RCU grace
4279  *	period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing the station.
4280  *	See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
4281  *	The callback can sleep.
4282  *
4283  * @sta_pre_rcu_remove: Notify driver about station removal before RCU
4284  *	synchronisation. This is useful if a driver needs to have station
4285  *	pointers protected using RCU, it can then use this call to clear
4286  *	the pointers instead of waiting for an RCU grace period to elapse
4287  *	in @sta_state.
4288  *	The callback can sleep.
4289  *
4290  * @link_sta_rc_update: Notifies the driver of changes to the bitrates that can
4291  *	be used to transmit to the station. The changes are advertised with bits
4292  *	from &enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed and the values are reflected
4293  *	in the station data. This callback should only be used when the driver
4294  *	uses hardware rate control (%IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL) since
4295  *	otherwise the rate control algorithm is notified directly.
4296  *	Must be atomic.
4297  * @sta_rate_tbl_update: Notifies the driver that the rate table changed. This
4298  *	is only used if the configured rate control algorithm actually uses
4299  *	the new rate table API, and is therefore optional. Must be atomic.
4300  *
4301  * @sta_statistics: Get statistics for this station. For example with beacon
4302  *	filtering, the statistics kept by mac80211 might not be accurate, so
4303  *	let the driver pre-fill the statistics. The driver can fill most of
4304  *	the values (indicating which by setting the filled bitmap), but not
4305  *	all of them make sense - see the source for which ones are possible.
4306  *	Statistics that the driver doesn't fill will be filled by mac80211.
4307  *	The callback can sleep.
4308  *
4309  * @link_sta_statistics: Get link statistics for this station. For example with
4310  *	beacon filtering, the statistics kept by mac80211 might not be
4311  *	accurate, so let the driver pre-fill the statistics. The driver can
4312  *	fill most of the values (indicating which by setting the filled
4313  *	bitmap), but not all of them make sense - see the source for which
4314  *	ones are possible.
4315  *	Statistics that the driver doesn't fill will be filled by mac80211.
4316  *	The callback can sleep.
4317  *
4318  * @conf_tx: Configure TX queue parameters (EDCF (aifs, cw_min, cw_max),
4319  *	bursting) for a hardware TX queue.
4320  *	Returns a negative error code on failure.
4321  *	The callback can sleep.
4322  *
4323  * @get_tsf: Get the current TSF timer value from firmware/hardware. Currently,
4324  *	this is only used for IBSS mode BSSID merging and debugging. Is not a
4325  *	required function.
4326  *	The callback can sleep.
4327  *
4328  * @set_tsf: Set the TSF timer to the specified value in the firmware/hardware.
4329  *	Currently, this is only used for IBSS mode debugging. Is not a
4330  *	required function.
4331  *	The callback can sleep.
4332  *
4333  * @offset_tsf: Offset the TSF timer by the specified value in the
4334  *	firmware/hardware.  Preferred to set_tsf as it avoids delay between
4335  *	calling set_tsf() and hardware getting programmed, which will show up
4336  *	as TSF delay. Is not a required function.
4337  *	The callback can sleep.
4338  *
4339  * @reset_tsf: Reset the TSF timer and allow firmware/hardware to synchronize
4340  *	with other STAs in the IBSS. This is only used in IBSS mode. This
4341  *	function is optional if the firmware/hardware takes full care of
4342  *	TSF synchronization.
4343  *	The callback can sleep.
4344  *
4345  * @tx_last_beacon: Determine whether the last IBSS beacon was sent by us.
4346  *	This is needed only for IBSS mode and the result of this function is
4347  *	used to determine whether to reply to Probe Requests.
4348  *	Returns non-zero if this device sent the last beacon.
4349  *	The callback can sleep.
4350  *
4351  * @get_survey: Return per-channel survey information
4352  *
4353  * @rfkill_poll: Poll rfkill hardware state. If you need this, you also
4354  *	need to set wiphy->rfkill_poll to %true before registration,
4355  *	and need to call wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state() in the callback.
4356  *	The callback can sleep.
4357  *
4358  * @set_coverage_class: Set slot time for given coverage class as specified
4359  *	in IEEE 802.11-2007 section 17.3.8.6 and modify ACK timeout
4360  *	accordingly; coverage class equals to -1 to enable ACK timeout
4361  *	estimation algorithm (dynack). To disable dynack set valid value for
4362  *	coverage class. This callback is not required and may sleep.
4363  *
4364  * @testmode_cmd: Implement a cfg80211 test mode command. The passed @vif may
4365  *	be %NULL. The callback can sleep.
4366  * @testmode_dump: Implement a cfg80211 test mode dump. The callback can sleep.
4367  *
4368  * @flush: Flush all pending frames from the hardware queue, making sure
4369  *	that the hardware queues are empty. The @queues parameter is a bitmap
4370  *	of queues to flush, which is useful if different virtual interfaces
4371  *	use different hardware queues; it may also indicate all queues.
4372  *	If the parameter @drop is set to %true, pending frames may be dropped.
4373  *	Note that vif can be NULL.
4374  *	The callback can sleep.
4375  *
4376  * @flush_sta: Flush or drop all pending frames from the hardware queue(s) for
4377  *	the given station, as it's about to be removed.
4378  *	The callback can sleep.
4379  *
4380  * @channel_switch: Drivers that need (or want) to offload the channel
4381  *	switch operation for CSAs received from the AP may implement this
4382  *	callback. They must then call ieee80211_chswitch_done() to indicate
4383  *	completion of the channel switch.
4384  *
4385  * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
4386  *	Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
4387  *	reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
4388  *	(also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
4389  *
4390  * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
4391  *
4392  * @remain_on_channel: Starts an off-channel period on the given channel, must
4393  *	call back to ieee80211_ready_on_channel() when on that channel. Note
4394  *	that normal channel traffic is not stopped as this is intended for hw
4395  *	offload. Frames to transmit on the off-channel channel are transmitted
4396  *	normally except for the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN flag. When the
4397  *	duration (which will always be non-zero) expires, the driver must call
4398  *	ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired().
4399  *	Note that this callback may be called while the device is in IDLE and
4400  *	must be accepted in this case.
4401  *	This callback may sleep.
4402  * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Requests that an ongoing off-channel period is
4403  *	aborted before it expires. This callback may sleep.
4404  *
4405  * @set_ringparam: Set tx and rx ring sizes.
4406  *
4407  * @get_ringparam: Get tx and rx ring current and maximum sizes.
4408  *
4409  * @tx_frames_pending: Check if there is any pending frame in the hardware
4410  *	queues before entering power save.
4411  *
4412  * @set_bitrate_mask: Set a mask of rates to be used for rate control selection
4413  *	when transmitting a frame. Currently only legacy rates are handled.
4414  *	The callback can sleep.
4415  * @event_callback: Notify driver about any event in mac80211. See
4416  *	&enum ieee80211_event_type for the different types.
4417  *	The callback must be atomic.
4418  *
4419  * @release_buffered_frames: Release buffered frames according to the given
4420  *	parameters. In the case where the driver buffers some frames for
4421  *	sleeping stations mac80211 will use this callback to tell the driver
4422  *	to release some frames, either for PS-poll or uAPSD.
4423  *	Note that if the @more_data parameter is %false the driver must check
4424  *	if there are more frames on the given TIDs, and if there are more than
4425  *	the frames being released then it must still set the more-data bit in
4426  *	the frame. If the @more_data parameter is %true, then of course the
4427  *	more-data bit must always be set.
4428  *	The @tids parameter tells the driver which TIDs to release frames
4429  *	from, for PS-poll it will always have only a single bit set.
4430  *	In the case this is used for a PS-poll initiated release, the
4431  *	@num_frames parameter will always be 1 so code can be shared. In
4432  *	this case the driver must also set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
4433  *	on the TX status (and must report TX status) so that the PS-poll
4434  *	period is properly ended. This is used to avoid sending multiple
4435  *	responses for a retried PS-poll frame.
4436  *	In the case this is used for uAPSD, the @num_frames parameter may be
4437  *	bigger than one, but the driver may send fewer frames (it must send
4438  *	at least one, however). In this case it is also responsible for
4439  *	setting the EOSP flag in the QoS header of the frames. Also, when the
4440  *	service period ends, the driver must set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP
4441  *	on the last frame in the SP. Alternatively, it may call the function
4442  *	ieee80211_sta_eosp() to inform mac80211 of the end of the SP.
4443  *	This callback must be atomic.
4444  * @allow_buffered_frames: Prepare device to allow the given number of frames
4445  *	to go out to the given station. The frames will be sent by mac80211
4446  *	via the usual TX path after this call. The TX information for frames
4447  *	released will also have the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER flag set
4448  *	and the last one will also have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set. In case
4449  *	frames from multiple TIDs are released and the driver might reorder
4450  *	them between the TIDs, it must set the %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
4451  *	on the last frame and clear it on all others and also handle the EOSP
4452  *	bit in the QoS header correctly. Alternatively, it can also call the
4453  *	ieee80211_sta_eosp() function.
4454  *	The @tids parameter is a bitmap and tells the driver which TIDs the
4455  *	frames will be on; it will at most have two bits set.
4456  *	This callback must be atomic.
4457  *
4458  * @get_et_sset_count:  Ethtool API to get string-set count.
4459  *	Note that the wiphy mutex is not held for this callback since it's
4460  *	expected to return a static value.
4461  *
4462  * @get_et_stats:  Ethtool API to get a set of u64 stats.
4463  *
4464  * @get_et_strings:  Ethtool API to get a set of strings to describe stats
4465  *	and perhaps other supported types of ethtool data-sets.
4466  *	Note that the wiphy mutex is not held for this callback since it's
4467  *	expected to return a static value.
4468  *
4469  * @mgd_prepare_tx: Prepare for transmitting a management frame for association
4470  *	before associated. In multi-channel scenarios, a virtual interface is
4471  *	bound to a channel before it is associated, but as it isn't associated
4472  *	yet it need not necessarily be given airtime, in particular since any
4473  *	transmission to a P2P GO needs to be synchronized against the GO's
4474  *	powersave state. mac80211 will call this function before transmitting a
4475  *	management frame prior to transmitting that frame to allow the driver
4476  *	to give it channel time for the transmission, to get a response and be
4477  *	able to synchronize with the GO.
4478  *	The callback will be called before each transmission and upon return
4479  *	mac80211 will transmit the frame right away.
4480  *	Additional information is passed in the &struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info
4481  *	data. If duration there is greater than zero, mac80211 hints to the
4482  *	driver the duration for which the operation is requested.
4483  *	The callback is optional and can (should!) sleep.
4484  * @mgd_complete_tx: Notify the driver that the response frame for a previously
4485  *	transmitted frame announced with @mgd_prepare_tx was received, the data
4486  *	is filled similarly to @mgd_prepare_tx though the duration is not used.
4487  *	Note that this isn't always called for each mgd_prepare_tx() call, for
4488  *	example for SAE the 'confirm' messages can be on the air in any order.
4489  *
4490  * @mgd_protect_tdls_discover: Protect a TDLS discovery session. After sending
4491  *	a TDLS discovery-request, we expect a reply to arrive on the AP's
4492  *	channel. We must stay on the channel (no PSM, scan, etc.), since a TDLS
4493  *	setup-response is a direct packet not buffered by the AP.
4494  *	mac80211 will call this function just before the transmission of a TDLS
4495  *	discovery-request. The recommended period of protection is at least
4496  *	2 * (DTIM period).
4497  *	The callback is optional and can sleep.
4498  *
4499  * @add_chanctx: Notifies device driver about new channel context creation.
4500  *	This callback may sleep.
4501  * @remove_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context destruction.
4502  *	This callback may sleep.
4503  * @change_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context changes that
4504  *	may happen when combining different virtual interfaces on the same
4505  *	channel context with different settings
4506  *	This callback may sleep.
4507  * @assign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being bound
4508  *	to vif. Possible use is for hw queue remapping.
4509  *	This callback may sleep.
4510  * @unassign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being
4511  *	unbound from vif.
4512  *	This callback may sleep.
4513  * @switch_vif_chanctx: switch a number of vifs from one chanctx to
4514  *	another, as specified in the list of
4515  *	@ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch passed to the driver, according
4516  *	to the mode defined in &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode.
4517  *	This callback may sleep.
4518  *
4519  * @start_ap: Start operation on the AP interface, this is called after all the
4520  *	information in bss_conf is set and beacon can be retrieved. A channel
4521  *	context is bound before this is called. Note that if the driver uses
4522  *	software scan or ROC, this (and @stop_ap) isn't called when the AP is
4523  *	just "paused" for scanning/ROC, which is indicated by the beacon being
4524  *	disabled/enabled via @bss_info_changed.
4525  * @stop_ap: Stop operation on the AP interface.
4526  *
4527  * @reconfig_complete: Called after a call to ieee80211_restart_hw() and
4528  *	during resume, when the reconfiguration has completed.
4529  *	This can help the driver implement the reconfiguration step (and
4530  *	indicate mac80211 is ready to receive frames).
4531  *	This callback may sleep.
4532  *
4533  * @ipv6_addr_change: IPv6 address assignment on the given interface changed.
4534  *	Currently, this is only called for managed or P2P client interfaces.
4535  *	This callback is optional; it must not sleep.
4536  *
4537  * @channel_switch_beacon: Starts a channel switch to a new channel.
4538  *	Beacons are modified to include CSA or ECSA IEs before calling this
4539  *	function. The corresponding count fields in these IEs must be
4540  *	decremented, and when they reach 1 the driver must call
4541  *	ieee80211_csa_finish(). Drivers which use ieee80211_beacon_get()
4542  *	get the csa counter decremented by mac80211, but must check if it is
4543  *	1 using ieee80211_beacon_counter_is_complete() after the beacon has been
4544  *	transmitted and then call ieee80211_csa_finish().
4545  *	If the CSA count starts as zero or 1, this function will not be called,
4546  *	since there won't be any time to beacon before the switch anyway.
4547  * @pre_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4548  *	before a channel switch procedure is started (ie. when a STA
4549  *	gets a CSA or a userspace initiated channel-switch), allowing
4550  *	the driver to prepare for the channel switch.
4551  * @post_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4552  *	after a channel switch procedure is completed, allowing the
4553  *	driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4554  * @abort_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4555  *	when channel switch procedure was aborted, allowing the
4556  *	driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4557  * @channel_switch_rx_beacon: This is an optional callback that is called
4558  *	when channel switch procedure is in progress and additional beacon with
4559  *	CSA IE was received, allowing driver to track changes in count.
4560  * @join_ibss: Join an IBSS (on an IBSS interface); this is called after all
4561  *	information in bss_conf is set up and the beacon can be retrieved. A
4562  *	channel context is bound before this is called.
4563  * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS again.
4564  *
4565  * @get_expected_throughput: extract the expected throughput towards the
4566  *	specified station. The returned value is expressed in Kbps. It returns 0
4567  *	if the RC algorithm does not have proper data to provide.
4568  *
4569  * @get_txpower: get current maximum tx power (in dBm) based on configuration
4570  *	and hardware limits.
4571  *
4572  * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver
4573  *	is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations
4574  *	and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP. The
4575  *	driver receives a channel-switch request template and the location of
4576  *	the switch-timing IE within the template as part of the invocation.
4577  *	The template is valid only within the call, and the driver can
4578  *	optionally copy the skb for further re-use.
4579  * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both
4580  *	peers must be on the base channel when the call completes.
4581  * @tdls_recv_channel_switch: a TDLS channel-switch related frame (request or
4582  *	response) has been received from a remote peer. The driver gets
4583  *	parameters parsed from the incoming frame and may use them to continue
4584  *	an ongoing channel-switch operation. In addition, a channel-switch
4585  *	response template is provided, together with the location of the
4586  *	switch-timing IE within the template. The skb can only be used within
4587  *	the function call.
4588  *
4589  * @wake_tx_queue: Called when new packets have been added to the queue.
4590  * @sync_rx_queues: Process all pending frames in RSS queues. This is a
4591  *	synchronization which is needed in case driver has in its RSS queues
4592  *	pending frames that were received prior to the control path action
4593  *	currently taken (e.g. disassociation) but are not processed yet.
4594  *
4595  * @start_nan: join an existing NAN cluster, or create a new one.
4596  * @stop_nan: leave the NAN cluster.
4597  * @nan_change_conf: change NAN configuration. The data in cfg80211_nan_conf
4598  *	contains full new configuration and changes specify which parameters
4599  *	are changed with respect to the last NAN config.
4600  *	The driver gets both full configuration and the changed parameters since
4601  *	some devices may need the full configuration while others need only the
4602  *	changed parameters.
4603  * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns 0 on success. The data in
4604  *	cfg80211_nan_func must not be referenced outside the scope of
4605  *	this call.
4606  * @del_nan_func: Remove a NAN function. The driver must call
4607  *	ieee80211_nan_func_terminated() with
4608  *	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST reason code upon removal.
4609  * @nan_peer_sched_changed: Notifies the driver that the peer NAN schedule
4610  *	has changed. The new schedule is available via sta->nan_sched.
4611  *	Note that the channel_entry blob might not match the actual chandef
4612  *	since the bandwidth of the chandef is the minimum of the local and peer
4613  *	bandwidth. It is the driver responsibility to remove the peer schedule
4614  *	when the NMI station is removed.
4615  * @can_aggregate_in_amsdu: Called in order to determine if HW supports
4616  *	aggregating two specific frames in the same A-MSDU. The relation
4617  *	between the skbs should be symmetric and transitive. Note that while
4618  *	skb is always a real frame, head may or may not be an A-MSDU.
4619  * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available.
4620  *	Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided.
4621  *
4622  * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM) (this call can sleep)
4623  * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement (this call can sleep)
4624  * @set_tid_config: Apply TID specific configurations. This callback may sleep.
4625  * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer.
4626  *	This callback may sleep.
4627  * @update_vif_offload: Update virtual interface offload flags
4628  *	This callback may sleep.
4629  * @sta_set_4addr: Called to notify the driver when a station starts/stops using
4630  *	4-address mode
4631  * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings.
4632  * @sta_set_decap_offload: Called to notify the driver when a station is allowed
4633  *	to use rx decapsulation offload
4634  * @add_twt_setup: Update hw with TWT agreement parameters received from the peer.
4635  *	This callback allows the hw to check if requested parameters
4636  *	are supported and if there is enough room for a new agreement.
4637  *	The hw is expected to set agreement result in the req_type field of
4638  *	twt structure.
4639  * @twt_teardown_request: Update the hw with TWT teardown request received
4640  *	from the peer.
4641  * @set_radar_background: Configure dedicated offchannel chain available for
4642  *	radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used to transmit
4643  *	or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev.
4644  *	Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime
4645  *	switching to a different channel during CAC detection on the selected
4646  *	radar channel.
4647  *	The caller is expected to set chandef pointer to NULL in order to
4648  *	disable background CAC/radar detection.
4649  * @net_fill_forward_path: Called from .ndo_fill_forward_path in order to
4650  *	resolve a path for hardware flow offloading
4651  * @can_activate_links: Checks if a specific active_links bitmap is
4652  *	supported by the driver.
4653  * @change_vif_links: Change the valid links on an interface, note that while
4654  *	removing the old link information is still valid (link_conf pointer),
4655  *	but may immediately disappear after the function returns. The old or
4656  *	new links bitmaps may be 0 if going from/to a non-MLO situation.
4657  *	The @old array contains pointers to the old bss_conf structures
4658  *	that were already removed, in case they're needed.
4659  *	Note that removal of link should always succeed, so the return value
4660  *	will be ignored in a removal only case.
4661  *	This callback can sleep.
4662  * @change_sta_links: Change the valid links of a station, similar to
4663  *	@change_vif_links. This callback can sleep.
4664  *	Note that a sta can also be inserted or removed with valid links,
4665  *	i.e. passed to @sta_add/@sta_state with sta->valid_links not zero.
4666  *	In fact, cannot change from having valid_links and not having them.
4667  * @set_hw_timestamp: Enable/disable HW timestamping of TM/FTM frames. This is
4668  *	not restored at HW reset by mac80211 so drivers need to take care of
4669  *	that.
4670  * @net_setup_tc: Called from .ndo_setup_tc in order to prepare hardware
4671  *	flow offloading for flows originating from the vif.
4672  *	Note that the driver must not assume that the vif driver_data is valid
4673  *	at this point, since the callback can be called during netdev teardown.
4674  * @can_neg_ttlm: for managed interface, requests the driver to determine
4675  *	if the requested TID-To-Link mapping can be accepted or not.
4676  *	If it's not accepted the driver may suggest a preferred mapping and
4677  *	modify @ttlm parameter with the suggested TID-to-Link mapping.
4678  * @prep_add_interface: prepare for interface addition. This can be used by
4679  *      drivers to prepare for the addition of a new interface, e.g., allocate
4680  *      the needed resources etc. This callback doesn't guarantee that an
4681  *      interface with the specified type would be added, and thus drivers that
4682  *      implement this callback need to handle such cases. The type is the full
4683  *      &enum nl80211_iftype.
4684  * @set_eml_op_mode: Configure eMLSR/eMLMR operation mode in the underlay
4685  *	driver according to the parameter received in the EML Operating mode
4686  *	notification frame.
4687  */
4688 struct ieee80211_ops {
4689 	void (*tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4690 		   struct ieee80211_tx_control *control,
4691 		   struct sk_buff *skb);
4692 	int (*start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4693 	void (*stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool suspend);
4694 #ifdef CONFIG_PM
4695 	int (*suspend)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan);
4696 	int (*resume)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4697 	void (*set_wakeup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool enabled);
4698 #endif
4699 	int (*add_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4700 			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4701 	int (*change_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4702 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4703 				enum nl80211_iftype new_type, bool p2p);
4704 	void (*remove_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4705 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4706 	int (*config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int radio_idx, u32 changed);
4707 	void (*bss_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4708 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4709 				 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4710 				 u64 changed);
4711 	void (*vif_cfg_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4712 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4713 				u64 changed);
4714 	void (*link_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4715 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4716 				  struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4717 				  u64 changed);
4718 
4719 	int (*start_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4720 			struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4721 	void (*stop_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4722 			struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4723 
4724 	u64 (*prepare_multicast)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4725 				 struct netdev_hw_addr_list *mc_list);
4726 	void (*configure_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4727 				 unsigned int changed_flags,
4728 				 unsigned int *total_flags,
4729 				 u64 multicast);
4730 	void (*config_iface_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4731 				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4732 				    unsigned int filter_flags,
4733 				    unsigned int changed_flags);
4734 	int (*set_tim)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4735 		       bool set);
4736 	int (*set_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, enum set_key_cmd cmd,
4737 		       struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4738 		       struct ieee80211_key_conf *key);
4739 	void (*update_tkip_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4740 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4741 				struct ieee80211_key_conf *conf,
4742 				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4743 				u32 iv32, u16 *phase1key);
4744 	void (*set_rekey_data)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4745 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4746 			       struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
4747 	void (*set_default_unicast_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4748 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int idx);
4749 	int (*hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4750 		       struct ieee80211_scan_request *req);
4751 	void (*cancel_hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4752 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4753 	int (*sched_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4754 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4755 				struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *req,
4756 				struct ieee80211_scan_ies *ies);
4757 	int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4758 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4759 	void (*sw_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4760 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4761 			      const u8 *mac_addr);
4762 	void (*sw_scan_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4763 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4764 	int (*get_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4765 			 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats *stats);
4766 	void (*get_key_seq)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4767 			    struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
4768 			    struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
4769 	int (*set_frag_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int radio_idx,
4770 				  u32 value);
4771 	int (*set_rts_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int radio_idx,
4772 				 u32 value);
4773 	int (*sta_add)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4774 		       struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4775 	int (*sta_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4776 			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4777 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
4778 	void (*vif_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4779 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4780 	void (*link_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4781 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4782 				 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4783 				 struct dentry *dir);
4784 	void (*sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4785 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4786 				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4787 				struct dentry *dir);
4788 	void (*link_sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4789 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4790 				     struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta,
4791 				     struct dentry *dir);
4792 #endif
4793 	void (*sta_notify)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4794 			enum sta_notify_cmd, struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4795 	int (*sta_set_txpwr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4796 			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4797 			     struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4798 	int (*sta_state)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4799 			 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4800 			 enum ieee80211_sta_state old_state,
4801 			 enum ieee80211_sta_state new_state);
4802 	void (*sta_pre_rcu_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4803 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4804 				   struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4805 	void (*link_sta_rc_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4806 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4807 				   struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta,
4808 				   u32 changed);
4809 	void (*sta_rate_tbl_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4810 				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4811 				    struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4812 	void (*sta_statistics)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4813 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4814 			       struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4815 			       struct station_info *sinfo);
4816 	int (*conf_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4817 		       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4818 		       unsigned int link_id, u16 ac,
4819 		       const struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params *params);
4820 	u64 (*get_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4821 	void (*set_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4822 			u64 tsf);
4823 	void (*offset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4824 			   s64 offset);
4825 	void (*reset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4826 	int (*tx_last_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4827 	void (*link_sta_statistics)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4828 				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4829 				    struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta,
4830 				    struct link_station_info *link_sinfo);
4831 
4832 	/**
4833 	 * @ampdu_action:
4834 	 * Perform a certain A-MPDU action.
4835 	 * The RA/TID combination determines the destination and TID we want
4836 	 * the ampdu action to be performed for. The action is defined through
4837 	 * ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
4838 	 * When the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL the driver
4839 	 * may neither send aggregates containing more subframes than @buf_size
4840 	 * nor send aggregates in a way that lost frames would exceed the
4841 	 * buffer size. If just limiting the aggregate size, this would be
4842 	 * possible with a buf_size of 8:
4843 	 *
4844 	 * - ``TX: 1.....7``
4845 	 * - ``RX:  2....7`` (lost frame #1)
4846 	 * - ``TX:        8..1...``
4847 	 *
4848 	 * which is invalid since #1 was now re-transmitted well past the
4849 	 * buffer size of 8. Correct ways to retransmit #1 would be:
4850 	 *
4851 	 * - ``TX:        1   or``
4852 	 * - ``TX:        18  or``
4853 	 * - ``TX:        81``
4854 	 *
4855 	 * Even ``189`` would be wrong since 1 could be lost again.
4856 	 *
4857 	 * Returns a negative error code on failure. The driver may return
4858 	 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE for %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START
4859 	 * if the session can start immediately.
4860 	 *
4861 	 * The callback can sleep.
4862 	 */
4863 	int (*ampdu_action)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4864 			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4865 			    struct ieee80211_ampdu_params *params);
4866 	int (*get_survey)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int idx,
4867 		struct survey_info *survey);
4868 	void (*rfkill_poll)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4869 	void (*set_coverage_class)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int radio_idx,
4870 				   s16 coverage_class);
4871 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
4872 	int (*testmode_cmd)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4873 			    void *data, int len);
4874 	int (*testmode_dump)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb,
4875 			     struct netlink_callback *cb,
4876 			     void *data, int len);
4877 #endif
4878 	void (*flush)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4879 		      u32 queues, bool drop);
4880 	void (*flush_sta)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4881 			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4882 	void (*channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4883 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4884 			       struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4885 	int (*set_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int radio_idx,
4886 			   u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
4887 	int (*get_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int radio_idx,
4888 			   u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);
4889 
4890 	int (*remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4891 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4892 				 struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
4893 				 int duration,
4894 				 enum ieee80211_roc_type type);
4895 	int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4896 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4897 	int (*set_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx, u32 rx);
4898 	void (*get_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4899 			      u32 *tx, u32 *tx_max, u32 *rx, u32 *rx_max);
4900 	bool (*tx_frames_pending)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4901 	int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4902 				const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
4903 	void (*event_callback)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4904 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4905 			       const struct ieee80211_event *event);
4906 
4907 	void (*allow_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4908 				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4909 				      u16 tids, int num_frames,
4910 				      enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4911 				      bool more_data);
4912 	void (*release_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4913 					struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4914 					u16 tids, int num_frames,
4915 					enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4916 					bool more_data);
4917 
4918 	int	(*get_et_sset_count)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4919 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int sset);
4920 	void	(*get_et_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4921 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4922 				struct ethtool_stats *stats, u64 *data);
4923 	void	(*get_et_strings)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4924 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4925 				  u32 sset, u8 *data);
4926 
4927 	void	(*mgd_prepare_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4928 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4929 				  struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4930 	void	(*mgd_complete_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4931 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4932 				   struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4933 
4934 	void	(*mgd_protect_tdls_discover)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4935 					     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4936 					     unsigned int link_id);
4937 
4938 	int (*add_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4939 			   struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4940 	void (*remove_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4941 			       struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4942 	void (*change_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4943 			       struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx,
4944 			       u32 changed);
4945 	int (*assign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4946 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4947 				  struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4948 				  struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4949 	void (*unassign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4950 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4951 				     struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4952 				     struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4953 	int (*switch_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4954 				  struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs,
4955 				  int n_vifs,
4956 				  enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode);
4957 
4958 	void (*reconfig_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4959 				  enum ieee80211_reconfig_type reconfig_type);
4960 
4961 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_IPV6)
4962 	void (*ipv6_addr_change)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4963 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4964 				 struct inet6_dev *idev);
4965 #endif
4966 	void (*channel_switch_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4967 				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4968 				      struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4969 	int (*pre_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4970 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4971 				  struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4972 
4973 	int (*post_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4974 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4975 				   struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4976 	void (*abort_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4977 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4978 				     struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4979 	void (*channel_switch_rx_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4980 					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4981 					 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4982 
4983 	int (*join_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4984 	void (*leave_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4985 	u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4986 				       struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4987 	int (*get_txpower)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4988 			   unsigned int link_id, int *dbm);
4989 
4990 	int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4991 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4992 				   struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 oper_class,
4993 				   struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
4994 				   struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb, u32 ch_sw_tm_ie);
4995 	void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4996 					   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4997 					   struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4998 	void (*tdls_recv_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4999 					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5000 					 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params *params);
5001 
5002 	void (*wake_tx_queue)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5003 			      struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
5004 	void (*sync_rx_queues)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5005 
5006 	int (*start_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5007 			 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5008 			 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf);
5009 	int (*stop_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5010 			struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5011 	int (*nan_change_conf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5012 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5013 			       struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf, u32 changes);
5014 	int (*add_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5015 			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5016 			    const struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func);
5017 	void (*del_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5018 			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5019 			    u8 instance_id);
5020 	int (*nan_peer_sched_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5021 				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
5022 	bool (*can_aggregate_in_amsdu)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5023 				       struct sk_buff *head,
5024 				       struct sk_buff *skb);
5025 	int (*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5026 				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5027 				       struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats);
5028 	int (*start_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5029 			  struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
5030 	void (*abort_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5031 			   struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
5032 	int (*set_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5033 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5034 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5035 			      struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf);
5036 	int (*reset_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5037 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5038 				struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tids);
5039 	void (*update_vif_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5040 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5041 	void (*sta_set_4addr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5042 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
5043 	int (*set_sar_specs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5044 			     const struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar);
5045 	void (*sta_set_decap_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5046 				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5047 				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
5048 	void (*add_twt_setup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5049 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5050 			      struct ieee80211_twt_setup *twt);
5051 	void (*twt_teardown_request)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5052 				     struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 flowid);
5053 	int (*set_radar_background)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5054 				    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
5055 	int (*net_fill_forward_path)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5056 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5057 				     struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5058 				     struct net_device_path_ctx *ctx,
5059 				     struct net_device_path *path);
5060 	bool (*can_activate_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5061 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5062 				   u16 active_links);
5063 	int (*change_vif_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5064 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5065 				u16 old_links, u16 new_links,
5066 				struct ieee80211_bss_conf *old[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]);
5067 	int (*change_sta_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5068 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5069 				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5070 				u16 old_links, u16 new_links);
5071 	int (*set_hw_timestamp)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5072 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5073 				struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp *hwts);
5074 	int (*net_setup_tc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5075 			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5076 			    struct net_device *dev,
5077 			    enum tc_setup_type type,
5078 			    void *type_data);
5079 	enum ieee80211_neg_ttlm_res
5080 	(*can_neg_ttlm)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5081 			struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm *ttlm);
5082 	void (*prep_add_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5083 				   enum nl80211_iftype type);
5084 	int (*set_eml_op_mode)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5085 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5086 			       struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5087 			       struct ieee80211_eml_params *eml_params);
5088 };
5089 
5090 /**
5091  * ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm - Allocate a new hardware device
5092  *
5093  * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
5094  * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
5095  * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
5096  * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
5097  * @priv_data_len.
5098  *
5099  * @priv_data_len: length of private data
5100  * @ops: callbacks for this device
5101  * @requested_name: Requested name for this device.
5102  *	NULL is valid value, and means use the default naming (phy%d)
5103  *
5104  * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
5105  */
5106 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(size_t priv_data_len,
5107 					   const struct ieee80211_ops *ops,
5108 					   const char *requested_name);
5109 
5110 /**
5111  * ieee80211_alloc_hw - Allocate a new hardware device
5112  *
5113  * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
5114  * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
5115  * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
5116  * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
5117  * @priv_data_len.
5118  *
5119  * @priv_data_len: length of private data
5120  * @ops: callbacks for this device
5121  *
5122  * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
5123  */
5124 static inline
5125 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len,
5126 					const struct ieee80211_ops *ops)
5127 {
5128 	return ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(priv_data_len, ops, NULL);
5129 }
5130 
5131 /**
5132  * ieee80211_register_hw - Register hardware device
5133  *
5134  * You must call this function before any other functions in
5135  * mac80211. Note that before a hardware can be registered, you
5136  * need to fill the contained wiphy's information.
5137  *
5138  * @hw: the device to register as returned by ieee80211_alloc_hw()
5139  *
5140  * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
5141  */
5142 int ieee80211_register_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5143 
5144 /**
5145  * struct ieee80211_tpt_blink - throughput blink description
5146  * @throughput: throughput in Kbit/sec
5147  * @blink_time: blink time in milliseconds
5148  *	(full cycle, ie. one off + one on period)
5149  */
5150 struct ieee80211_tpt_blink {
5151 	int throughput;
5152 	int blink_time;
5153 };
5154 
5155 /**
5156  * enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags - throughput trigger flags
5157  * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO: enable blinking with radio
5158  * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK: enable blinking when working
5159  * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED: enable blinking when at least one
5160  *	interface is connected in some way, including being an AP
5161  */
5162 enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags {
5163 	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO		= BIT(0),
5164 	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK		= BIT(1),
5165 	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED	= BIT(2),
5166 };
5167 
5168 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
5169 const char *__ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5170 const char *__ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5171 const char *__ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5172 const char *__ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5173 const char *
5174 __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5175 				   unsigned int flags,
5176 				   const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
5177 				   unsigned int blink_table_len);
5178 #endif
5179 /**
5180  * ieee80211_get_tx_led_name - get name of TX LED
5181  *
5182  * mac80211 creates a transmit LED trigger for each wireless hardware
5183  * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
5184  * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
5185  * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
5186  *
5187  * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
5188  *
5189  * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
5190  */
5191 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
5192 {
5193 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
5194 	return __ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(hw);
5195 #else
5196 	return NULL;
5197 #endif
5198 }
5199 
5200 /**
5201  * ieee80211_get_rx_led_name - get name of RX LED
5202  *
5203  * mac80211 creates a receive LED trigger for each wireless hardware
5204  * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
5205  * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
5206  * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
5207  *
5208  * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
5209  *
5210  * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
5211  */
5212 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
5213 {
5214 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
5215 	return __ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(hw);
5216 #else
5217 	return NULL;
5218 #endif
5219 }
5220 
5221 /**
5222  * ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name - get name of association LED
5223  *
5224  * mac80211 creates a association LED trigger for each wireless hardware
5225  * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
5226  * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
5227  * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
5228  *
5229  * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
5230  *
5231  * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
5232  */
5233 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
5234 {
5235 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
5236 	return __ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(hw);
5237 #else
5238 	return NULL;
5239 #endif
5240 }
5241 
5242 /**
5243  * ieee80211_get_radio_led_name - get name of radio LED
5244  *
5245  * mac80211 creates a radio change LED trigger for each wireless hardware
5246  * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
5247  * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
5248  * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
5249  *
5250  * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
5251  *
5252  * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
5253  */
5254 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
5255 {
5256 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
5257 	return __ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(hw);
5258 #else
5259 	return NULL;
5260 #endif
5261 }
5262 
5263 /**
5264  * ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger - create throughput LED trigger
5265  * @hw: the hardware to create the trigger for
5266  * @flags: trigger flags, see &enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags
5267  * @blink_table: the blink table -- needs to be ordered by throughput
5268  * @blink_table_len: size of the blink table
5269  *
5270  * Return: %NULL (in case of error, or if no LED triggers are
5271  * configured) or the name of the new trigger.
5272  *
5273  * Note: This function must be called before ieee80211_register_hw().
5274  */
5275 static inline const char *
5276 ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, unsigned int flags,
5277 				 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
5278 				 unsigned int blink_table_len)
5279 {
5280 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
5281 	return __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(hw, flags, blink_table,
5282 						  blink_table_len);
5283 #else
5284 	return NULL;
5285 #endif
5286 }
5287 
5288 /**
5289  * ieee80211_unregister_hw - Unregister a hardware device
5290  *
5291  * This function instructs mac80211 to free allocated resources
5292  * and unregister netdevices from the networking subsystem.
5293  *
5294  * @hw: the hardware to unregister
5295  */
5296 void ieee80211_unregister_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5297 
5298 /**
5299  * ieee80211_free_hw - free hardware descriptor
5300  *
5301  * This function frees everything that was allocated, including the
5302  * private data for the driver. You must call ieee80211_unregister_hw()
5303  * before calling this function.
5304  *
5305  * @hw: the hardware to free
5306  */
5307 void ieee80211_free_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5308 
5309 /**
5310  * ieee80211_restart_hw - restart hardware completely
5311  *
5312  * Call this function when the hardware was restarted for some reason
5313  * (hardware error, ...) and the driver is unable to restore its state
5314  * by itself. mac80211 assumes that at this point the driver/hardware
5315  * is completely uninitialised and stopped, it starts the process by
5316  * calling the ->start() operation. The driver will need to reset all
5317  * internal state that it has prior to calling this function.
5318  *
5319  * @hw: the hardware to restart
5320  */
5321 void ieee80211_restart_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5322 
5323 /**
5324  * ieee80211_rx_list - receive frame and store processed skbs in a list
5325  *
5326  * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
5327  * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
5328  * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
5329  * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
5330  * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
5331  *
5332  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5333  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
5334  * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
5335  * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5336  * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5337  *
5338  * This function must be called with BHs disabled and RCU read lock
5339  *
5340  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5341  * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
5342  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5343  * @list: the destination list
5344  */
5345 void ieee80211_rx_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5346 		       struct sk_buff *skb, struct list_head *list);
5347 
5348 /**
5349  * ieee80211_rx_napi - receive frame from NAPI context
5350  *
5351  * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
5352  * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
5353  * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
5354  * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
5355  * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
5356  *
5357  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5358  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
5359  * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
5360  * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5361  * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5362  *
5363  * This function must be called with BHs disabled.
5364  *
5365  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5366  * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
5367  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5368  * @napi: the NAPI context
5369  */
5370 void ieee80211_rx_napi(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5371 		       struct sk_buff *skb, struct napi_struct *napi);
5372 
5373 /**
5374  * ieee80211_rx - receive frame
5375  *
5376  * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
5377  * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
5378  * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
5379  * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
5380  * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
5381  *
5382  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5383  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
5384  * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
5385  * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5386  * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5387  *
5388  * In process context use instead ieee80211_rx_ni().
5389  *
5390  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5391  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5392  */
5393 static inline void ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb)
5394 {
5395 	ieee80211_rx_napi(hw, NULL, skb, NULL);
5396 }
5397 
5398 /**
5399  * ieee80211_rx_irqsafe - receive frame
5400  *
5401  * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in IRQ context
5402  * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
5403  *
5404  * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni() may not
5405  * be mixed for a single hardware.Must not run concurrently with
5406  * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5407  *
5408  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5409  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5410  */
5411 void ieee80211_rx_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
5412 
5413 /**
5414  * ieee80211_rx_ni - receive frame (in process context)
5415  *
5416  * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in process context
5417  * (internally disables bottom halves).
5418  *
5419  * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may
5420  * not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5421  * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5422  *
5423  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5424  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5425  */
5426 static inline void ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5427 				   struct sk_buff *skb)
5428 {
5429 	local_bh_disable();
5430 	ieee80211_rx(hw, skb);
5431 	local_bh_enable();
5432 }
5433 
5434 /**
5435  * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition - PS transition for connected sta
5436  *
5437  * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS
5438  * flag set, use this function to inform mac80211 about a connected station
5439  * entering/leaving PS mode.
5440  *
5441  * This function may not be called in IRQ context or with softirqs enabled.
5442  *
5443  * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized against
5444  * each other.
5445  *
5446  * @sta: currently connected sta
5447  * @start: start or stop PS
5448  *
5449  * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL when the requested PS mode is already set.
5450  */
5451 int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool start);
5452 
5453 /**
5454  * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni - PS transition for connected sta
5455  *                                  (in process context)
5456  *
5457  * Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() but can be called in process context
5458  * (internally disables bottom halves). Concurrent call restriction still
5459  * applies.
5460  *
5461  * @sta: currently connected sta
5462  * @start: start or stop PS
5463  *
5464  * Return: Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition().
5465  */
5466 static inline int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5467 						  bool start)
5468 {
5469 	int ret;
5470 
5471 	local_bh_disable();
5472 	ret = ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(sta, start);
5473 	local_bh_enable();
5474 
5475 	return ret;
5476 }
5477 
5478 /**
5479  * ieee80211_sta_pspoll - PS-Poll frame received
5480  * @sta: currently connected station
5481  *
5482  * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
5483  * use this function to inform mac80211 that a PS-Poll frame from a
5484  * connected station was received.
5485  * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
5486  * and possibly ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(); calls to all three must
5487  * be serialized.
5488  */
5489 void ieee80211_sta_pspoll(struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
5490 
5491 /**
5492  * ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger - (potential) U-APSD trigger frame received
5493  * @sta: currently connected station
5494  * @tid: TID of the received (potential) trigger frame
5495  *
5496  * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
5497  * use this function to inform mac80211 that a (potential) trigger frame
5498  * from a connected station was received.
5499  * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
5500  * and possibly ieee80211_sta_pspoll(); calls to all three must be
5501  * serialized.
5502  * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS can be passed as the tid if the tid is unknown.
5503  * In this case, mac80211 will not check that this tid maps to an AC
5504  * that is trigger enabled and assume that the caller did the proper
5505  * checks.
5506  */
5507 void ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
5508 
5509 /*
5510  * The TX headroom reserved by mac80211 for its own tx_status functions.
5511  * This is enough for the radiotap header.
5512  */
5513 #define IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_HEADROOM	ALIGN(14, 4)
5514 
5515 /**
5516  * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered - inform mac80211 about driver-buffered frames
5517  * @sta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer for the sleeping station
5518  * @tid: the TID that has buffered frames
5519  * @buffered: indicates whether or not frames are buffered for this TID
5520  *
5521  * If a driver buffers frames for a powersave station instead of passing
5522  * them back to mac80211 for retransmission, the station may still need
5523  * to be told that there are buffered frames via the TIM bit.
5524  *
5525  * This function informs mac80211 whether or not there are frames that are
5526  * buffered in the driver for a given TID; mac80211 can then use this data
5527  * to set the TIM bit (NOTE: This may call back into the driver's set_tim
5528  * call! Beware of the locking!)
5529  *
5530  * If all frames are released to the station (due to PS-poll or uAPSD)
5531  * then the driver needs to inform mac80211 that there no longer are
5532  * frames buffered. However, when the station wakes up mac80211 assumes
5533  * that all buffered frames will be transmitted and clears this data,
5534  * drivers need to make sure they inform mac80211 about all buffered
5535  * frames on the sleep transition (sta_notify() with %STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP).
5536  *
5537  * Note that technically mac80211 only needs to know this per AC, not per
5538  * TID, but since driver buffering will inevitably happen per TID (since
5539  * it is related to aggregation) it is easier to make mac80211 map the
5540  * TID to the AC as required instead of keeping track in all drivers that
5541  * use this API.
5542  */
5543 void ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5544 				u8 tid, bool buffered);
5545 
5546 /**
5547  * ieee80211_get_tx_rates - get the selected transmit rates for a packet
5548  *
5549  * Call this function in a driver with per-packet rate selection support
5550  * to combine the rate info in the packet tx info with the most recent
5551  * rate selection table for the station entry.
5552  *
5553  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5554  * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent.
5555  * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
5556  * @dest: buffer for extracted rate/retry information
5557  * @max_rates: maximum number of rates to fetch
5558  */
5559 void ieee80211_get_tx_rates(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5560 			    struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5561 			    struct sk_buff *skb,
5562 			    struct ieee80211_tx_rate *dest,
5563 			    int max_rates);
5564 
5565 /**
5566  * ieee80211_tx_rate_update - transmit rate update callback
5567  *
5568  * Drivers should call this functions with a non-NULL pub sta
5569  * This function can be used in drivers that does not have provision
5570  * in updating the tx rate in data path.
5571  *
5572  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5573  * @pubsta: the station to update the tx rate for.
5574  * @info: tx status information
5575  */
5576 void ieee80211_tx_rate_update(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5577 			      struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
5578 			      struct ieee80211_tx_info *info);
5579 
5580 /**
5581  * ieee80211_tx_status_skb - transmit status callback
5582  *
5583  * Call this function for all transmitted frames after they have been
5584  * transmitted. It is permissible to not call this function for
5585  * multicast frames but this can affect statistics.
5586  *
5587  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5588  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls
5589  * to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe()
5590  * may not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5591  * ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni().
5592  *
5593  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5594  * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5595  */
5596 void ieee80211_tx_status_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5597 			     struct sk_buff *skb);
5598 
5599 /**
5600  * ieee80211_tx_status_ext - extended transmit status callback
5601  *
5602  * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status_skb()
5603  * in drivers that may want to provide extra information that does not
5604  * fit into &struct ieee80211_tx_info.
5605  *
5606  * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5607  * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5608  * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5609  *
5610  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5611  * @status: tx status information
5612  */
5613 void ieee80211_tx_status_ext(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5614 			     struct ieee80211_tx_status *status);
5615 
5616 /**
5617  * ieee80211_tx_status_noskb - transmit status callback without skb
5618  *
5619  * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status_skb()
5620  * in drivers that cannot reliably map tx status information back to
5621  * specific skbs.
5622  *
5623  * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5624  * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5625  * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5626  *
5627  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5628  * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent
5629  *	(NULL for multicast packets)
5630  * @info: tx status information
5631  */
5632 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5633 					     struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5634 					     struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
5635 {
5636 	struct ieee80211_tx_status status = {
5637 		.sta = sta,
5638 		.info = info,
5639 	};
5640 
5641 	ieee80211_tx_status_ext(hw, &status);
5642 }
5643 
5644 /**
5645  * ieee80211_tx_status_ni - transmit status callback (in process context)
5646  *
5647  * Like ieee80211_tx_status_skb() but can be called in process context.
5648  *
5649  * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_skb() and
5650  * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed
5651  * for a single hardware.
5652  *
5653  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5654  * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5655  */
5656 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5657 					  struct sk_buff *skb)
5658 {
5659 	local_bh_disable();
5660 	ieee80211_tx_status_skb(hw, skb);
5661 	local_bh_enable();
5662 }
5663 
5664 /**
5665  * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe - IRQ-safe transmit status callback
5666  *
5667  * Like ieee80211_tx_status_skb() but can be called in IRQ context
5668  * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
5669  *
5670  * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_skb() and
5671  * ieee80211_tx_status_ni() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5672  *
5673  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5674  * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5675  */
5676 void ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5677 				 struct sk_buff *skb);
5678 
5679 /**
5680  * ieee80211_report_low_ack - report non-responding station
5681  *
5682  * When operating in AP-mode, call this function to report a non-responding
5683  * connected STA.
5684  *
5685  * @sta: the non-responding connected sta
5686  * @num_packets: number of packets sent to @sta without a response
5687  */
5688 void ieee80211_report_low_ack(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u32 num_packets);
5689 
5690 #define IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM 2
5691 
5692 /**
5693  * struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets - mutable beacon offsets
5694  * @tim_offset: position of TIM element
5695  * @tim_length: size of TIM element
5696  * @cntdwn_counter_offs: array of IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM offsets
5697  *	to countdown counters.  This array can contain zero values which
5698  *	should be ignored.
5699  * @mbssid_off: position of the multiple bssid element
5700  */
5701 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets {
5702 	u16 tim_offset;
5703 	u16 tim_length;
5704 
5705 	u16 cntdwn_counter_offs[IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM];
5706 	u16 mbssid_off;
5707 };
5708 
5709 /**
5710  * ieee80211_beacon_get_template - beacon template generation function
5711  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5712  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5713  * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5714  *	receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5715  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5716  *	that is not associated with AP MLD).
5717  *
5718  * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5719  * obtain the beacon template.
5720  *
5721  * This function should be used if the beacon frames are generated by the
5722  * device, and then the driver must use the returned beacon as the template
5723  * The driver or the device are responsible to update the DTIM and, when
5724  * applicable, the CSA count.
5725  *
5726  * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5727  *
5728  * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5729  */
5730 struct sk_buff *
5731 ieee80211_beacon_get_template(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5732 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5733 			      struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs,
5734 			      unsigned int link_id);
5735 
5736 /**
5737  * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index - EMA beacon template generation
5738  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5739  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5740  * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5741  *	receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5742  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP).
5743  * @ema_index: index of the beacon in the EMA set.
5744  *
5745  * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template()
5746  * but returns a beacon template which includes multiple BSSID element at the
5747  * requested index.
5748  *
5749  * Return: The beacon template. %NULL indicates the end of EMA templates.
5750  */
5751 struct sk_buff *
5752 ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5753 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5754 					struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs,
5755 					unsigned int link_id, u8 ema_index);
5756 
5757 /**
5758  * struct ieee80211_ema_beacons - List of EMA beacons
5759  * @cnt: count of EMA beacons.
5760  *
5761  * @bcn: array of EMA beacons.
5762  * @bcn.skb: the skb containing this specific beacon
5763  * @bcn.offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5764  *	receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5765  */
5766 struct ieee80211_ema_beacons {
5767 	u8 cnt;
5768 	struct {
5769 		struct sk_buff *skb;
5770 		struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets offs;
5771 	} bcn[];
5772 };
5773 
5774 /**
5775  * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list - EMA beacon template generation
5776  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5777  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5778  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP)
5779  *
5780  * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template()
5781  * but allocates and returns a pointer to list of all beacon templates required
5782  * to cover all profiles in the multiple BSSID set. Each template includes only
5783  * one multiple BSSID element.
5784  *
5785  * Driver must call ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list() to free the memory.
5786  *
5787  * Return: EMA beacon templates of type struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *.
5788  *	%NULL on error.
5789  */
5790 struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *
5791 ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5792 				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5793 				       unsigned int link_id);
5794 
5795 /**
5796  * ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list - free an EMA beacon template list
5797  * @ema_beacons: list of EMA beacons of type &struct ieee80211_ema_beacons pointers.
5798  *
5799  * This function will free a list previously acquired by calling
5800  * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list()
5801  */
5802 void ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list(struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *ema_beacons);
5803 
5804 /**
5805  * ieee80211_beacon_get_tim - beacon generation function
5806  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5807  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5808  * @tim_offset: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE offset.
5809  *	Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5810  * @tim_length: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE length,
5811  *	(including the ID and length bytes!).
5812  *	Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5813  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5814  *	that is not associated with AP MLD).
5815  *
5816  * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5817  * obtain the beacon frame.
5818  *
5819  * If the beacon frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5820  * hardware/firmware), the driver uses this function to get each beacon
5821  * frame from mac80211 -- it is responsible for calling this function exactly
5822  * once before the beacon is needed (e.g. based on hardware interrupt).
5823  *
5824  * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5825  *
5826  * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5827  */
5828 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5829 					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5830 					 u16 *tim_offset, u16 *tim_length,
5831 					 unsigned int link_id);
5832 
5833 /**
5834  * ieee80211_beacon_get - beacon generation function
5835  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5836  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5837  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5838  *	that is not associated with AP MLD).
5839  *
5840  * See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5841  *
5842  * Return: See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5843  */
5844 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5845 						   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5846 						   unsigned int link_id)
5847 {
5848 	return ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(hw, vif, NULL, NULL, link_id);
5849 }
5850 
5851 /**
5852  * ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn - request mac80211 to decrement the beacon countdown
5853  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5854  * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5855  *
5856  * The beacon counter should be updated after each beacon transmission.
5857  * This function is called implicitly when
5858  * ieee80211_beacon_get/ieee80211_beacon_get_tim are called, however if the
5859  * beacon frames are generated by the device, the driver should call this
5860  * function after each beacon transmission to sync mac80211's beacon countdown.
5861  *
5862  * Return: new countdown value
5863  */
5864 u8 ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5865 				  unsigned int link_id);
5866 
5867 /**
5868  * ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn - request mac80211 to set beacon countdown
5869  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5870  * @counter: the new value for the counter
5871  *
5872  * The beacon countdown can be changed by the device, this API should be
5873  * used by the device driver to update csa counter in mac80211.
5874  *
5875  * It should never be used together with ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(),
5876  * as it will cause a race condition around the counter value.
5877  */
5878 void ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 counter);
5879 
5880 /**
5881  * ieee80211_csa_finish - notify mac80211 about channel switch
5882  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5883  * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5884  *
5885  * After a channel switch announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5886  * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5887  * notify mac80211 that the channel can be changed.
5888  */
5889 void ieee80211_csa_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id);
5890 
5891 /**
5892  * ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete - find out if countdown reached 1
5893  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5894  * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5895  *
5896  * Return: %true if the countdown reached 1, %false otherwise
5897  */
5898 bool ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5899 					 unsigned int link_id);
5900 
5901 /**
5902  * ieee80211_color_change_finish - notify mac80211 about color change
5903  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5904  * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
5905  *
5906  * After a color change announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5907  * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5908  * notify mac80211 that the color can be changed
5909  */
5910 void ieee80211_color_change_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 link_id);
5911 
5912 /**
5913  * ieee80211_proberesp_get - retrieve a Probe Response template
5914  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5915  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5916  *
5917  * Creates a Probe Response template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5918  * hardware. The destination address should be set by the caller.
5919  *
5920  * Can only be called in AP mode.
5921  *
5922  * Return: The Probe Response template. %NULL on error.
5923  */
5924 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_proberesp_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5925 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5926 
5927 /**
5928  * ieee80211_pspoll_get - retrieve a PS Poll template
5929  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5930  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5931  *
5932  * Creates a PS Poll a template which can, for example, uploaded to
5933  * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5934  * AID, BSSID and MAC address is used.
5935  *
5936  * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5937  * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit.
5938  *
5939  * Return: The PS Poll template. %NULL on error.
5940  */
5941 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_pspoll_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5942 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5943 
5944 /**
5945  * ieee80211_nullfunc_get - retrieve a nullfunc template
5946  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5947  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5948  * @link_id: If the vif is an MLD, get a frame with the link addresses
5949  *	for the given link ID. For a link_id < 0 you get a frame with
5950  *	MLD addresses, however useful that might be.
5951  * @qos_ok: QoS NDP is acceptable to the caller, this should be set
5952  *	if at all possible
5953  *
5954  * Creates a Nullfunc template which can, for example, uploaded to
5955  * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5956  * BSSID and address is used.
5957  *
5958  * If @qos_ndp is set and the association is to an AP with QoS/WMM, the
5959  * returned packet will be QoS NDP.
5960  *
5961  * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5962  * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit as well as Duration and Sequence Control fields.
5963  *
5964  * Return: The nullfunc template. %NULL on error.
5965  */
5966 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_nullfunc_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5967 				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5968 				       int link_id, bool qos_ok);
5969 
5970 /**
5971  * ieee80211_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
5972  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5973  * @src_addr: source MAC address
5974  * @ssid: SSID buffer
5975  * @ssid_len: length of SSID
5976  * @tailroom: tailroom to reserve at end of SKB for IEs
5977  *
5978  * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5979  * hardware.
5980  *
5981  * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
5982  */
5983 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5984 				       const u8 *src_addr,
5985 				       const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
5986 				       size_t tailroom);
5987 
5988 /**
5989  * ieee80211_rts_get - RTS frame generation function
5990  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5991  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5992  * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5993  * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5994  * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5995  * @rts: The buffer where to store the RTS frame.
5996  *
5997  * If the RTS frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5998  * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5999  * the next RTS frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
6000  * for calling this function before and RTS frame is needed.
6001  */
6002 void ieee80211_rts_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6003 		       const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
6004 		       const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
6005 		       struct ieee80211_rts *rts);
6006 
6007 /**
6008  * ieee80211_rts_duration - Get the duration field for an RTS frame
6009  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6010  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6011  * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
6012  * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
6013  *
6014  * If the RTS is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
6015  * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
6016  * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
6017  *
6018  * Return: The duration.
6019  */
6020 __le16 ieee80211_rts_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6021 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif, size_t frame_len,
6022 			      const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
6023 
6024 /**
6025  * ieee80211_ctstoself_get - CTS-to-self frame generation function
6026  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6027  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6028  * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
6029  * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
6030  * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
6031  * @cts: The buffer where to store the CTS-to-self frame.
6032  *
6033  * If the CTS-to-self frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
6034  * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
6035  * the next CTS-to-self frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
6036  * for calling this function before and CTS-to-self frame is needed.
6037  */
6038 void ieee80211_ctstoself_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6039 			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6040 			     const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
6041 			     const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
6042 			     struct ieee80211_cts *cts);
6043 
6044 /**
6045  * ieee80211_ctstoself_duration - Get the duration field for a CTS-to-self frame
6046  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6047  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6048  * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
6049  * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
6050  *
6051  * If the CTS-to-self is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
6052  * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
6053  * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
6054  *
6055  * Return: The duration.
6056  */
6057 __le16 ieee80211_ctstoself_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6058 				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6059 				    size_t frame_len,
6060 				    const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
6061 
6062 /**
6063  * ieee80211_generic_frame_duration - Calculate the duration field for a frame
6064  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6065  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6066  * @band: the band to calculate the frame duration on
6067  * @frame_len: the length of the frame.
6068  * @rate: the rate at which the frame is going to be transmitted.
6069  *
6070  * Calculate the duration field of some generic frame, given its
6071  * length and transmission rate (in 100kbps).
6072  *
6073  * Return: The duration.
6074  */
6075 __le16 ieee80211_generic_frame_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6076 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6077 					enum nl80211_band band,
6078 					size_t frame_len,
6079 					struct ieee80211_rate *rate);
6080 
6081 /**
6082  * ieee80211_get_buffered_bc - accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames
6083  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6084  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6085  *
6086  * Function for accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames. If
6087  * hardware/firmware does not implement buffering of broadcast/multicast
6088  * frames when power saving is used, 802.11 code buffers them in the host
6089  * memory. The low-level driver uses this function to fetch next buffered
6090  * frame. In most cases, this is used when generating beacon frame.
6091  *
6092  * Return: A pointer to the next buffered skb or NULL if no more buffered
6093  * frames are available.
6094  *
6095  * Note: buffered frames are returned only after DTIM beacon frame was
6096  * generated with ieee80211_beacon_get() and the low-level driver must thus
6097  * call ieee80211_beacon_get() first. ieee80211_get_buffered_bc() returns
6098  * NULL if the previous generated beacon was not DTIM, so the low-level driver
6099  * does not need to check for DTIM beacons separately and should be able to
6100  * use common code for all beacons.
6101  */
6102 struct sk_buff *
6103 ieee80211_get_buffered_bc(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6104 
6105 /**
6106  * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv - get a TKIP phase 1 key for IV32
6107  *
6108  * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32.
6109  *
6110  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
6111  * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
6112  * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
6113  */
6114 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
6115 			       u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
6116 
6117 /**
6118  * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key
6119  *
6120  * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the IV32 taken
6121  * from the given packet.
6122  *
6123  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
6124  * @skb: the packet to take the IV32 value from that will be encrypted
6125  *	with this P1K
6126  * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
6127  */
6128 static inline void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
6129 					  struct sk_buff *skb, u16 *p1k)
6130 {
6131 	struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (struct ieee80211_hdr *)skb->data;
6132 	const u8 *data = (u8 *)hdr + ieee80211_hdrlen(hdr->frame_control);
6133 	u32 iv32 = get_unaligned_le32(&data[4]);
6134 
6135 	ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(keyconf, iv32, p1k);
6136 }
6137 
6138 /**
6139  * ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key for RX
6140  *
6141  * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32
6142  * and transmitter address.
6143  *
6144  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
6145  * @ta: TA that will be used with the key
6146  * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
6147  * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
6148  */
6149 void ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
6150 			       const u8 *ta, u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
6151 
6152 /**
6153  * ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k - get a TKIP phase 2 key
6154  *
6155  * This function computes the TKIP RC4 key for the IV values
6156  * in the packet.
6157  *
6158  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
6159  * @skb: the packet to take the IV32/IV16 values from that will be
6160  *	encrypted with this key
6161  * @p2k: a buffer to which the key will be written, 16 bytes
6162  */
6163 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
6164 			    struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *p2k);
6165 
6166 /**
6167  * ieee80211_tkip_add_iv - write TKIP IV and Ext. IV to pos
6168  *
6169  * @pos: start of crypto header
6170  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
6171  * @pn: PN to add
6172  *
6173  * Returns: pointer to the octet following IVs (i.e. beginning of
6174  * the packet payload)
6175  *
6176  * This function writes the tkip IV value to pos (which should
6177  * point to the crypto header)
6178  */
6179 u8 *ieee80211_tkip_add_iv(u8 *pos, struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, u64 pn);
6180 
6181 /**
6182  * ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq - get key RX sequence counter
6183  *
6184  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
6185  * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
6186  *	the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
6187  *	CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
6188  * @seq: buffer to receive the sequence data
6189  *
6190  * This function allows a driver to retrieve the current RX IV/PNs
6191  * for the given key. It must not be called if IV checking is done
6192  * by the device and not by mac80211.
6193  *
6194  * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
6195  * can be done concurrently.
6196  */
6197 void ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
6198 			      int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
6199 
6200 /**
6201  * ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq - set key RX sequence counter
6202  *
6203  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
6204  * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
6205  *	the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
6206  *	CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
6207  * @seq: new sequence data
6208  *
6209  * This function allows a driver to set the current RX IV/PNs for the
6210  * given key. This is useful when resuming from WoWLAN sleep and GTK
6211  * rekey may have been done while suspended. It should not be called
6212  * if IV checking is done by the device and not by mac80211.
6213  *
6214  * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
6215  * can be done concurrently.
6216  */
6217 void ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
6218 			      int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
6219 
6220 /**
6221  * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add - add a GTK key from rekeying during WoWLAN
6222  * @vif: the virtual interface to add the key on
6223  * @idx: the keyidx of the key
6224  * @key_data: the key data
6225  * @key_len: the key data. Might be bigger than the actual key length,
6226  *	but not smaller (for the driver convinence)
6227  * @link_id: the link id of the key or -1 for non-MLO
6228  *
6229  * When GTK rekeying was done while the system was suspended, (a) new
6230  * key(s) will be available. These will be needed by mac80211 for proper
6231  * RX processing, so this function allows setting them.
6232  *
6233  * Return: the newly allocated key structure, which will have
6234  * similar contents to the passed key configuration but point to
6235  * mac80211-owned memory. In case of errors, the function returns an
6236  * ERR_PTR(), use IS_ERR() etc.
6237  *
6238  * Note that this function assumes the key isn't added to hardware
6239  * acceleration, so no TX will be done with the key. Since it's a GTK
6240  * on managed (station) networks, this is true anyway. If the driver
6241  * calls this function from the resume callback and subsequently uses
6242  * the return code 1 to reconfigure the device, this key will be part
6243  * of the reconfiguration.
6244  *
6245  * Note that the driver should also call ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq()
6246  * for the new key for each TID to set up sequence counters properly.
6247  *
6248  * IMPORTANT: If this replaces a key that is present in the hardware,
6249  * then it will attempt to remove it during this call.
6250  */
6251 struct ieee80211_key_conf *
6252 ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6253 			u8 idx, u8 *key_data, u8 key_len,
6254 			int link_id);
6255 
6256 /**
6257  * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace supplicant of rekeying
6258  * @vif: virtual interface the rekeying was done on
6259  * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP, for checking association
6260  * @replay_ctr: the new replay counter after GTK rekeying
6261  * @gfp: allocation flags
6262  */
6263 void ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *bssid,
6264 				const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);
6265 
6266 /**
6267  * ieee80211_key_mic_failure - increment MIC failure counter for the key
6268  *
6269  * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
6270  * at the same time.
6271  *
6272  * @keyconf: the key in question
6273  */
6274 void ieee80211_key_mic_failure(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
6275 
6276 /**
6277  * ieee80211_key_replay - increment replay counter for the key
6278  *
6279  * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
6280  * at the same time.
6281  *
6282  * @keyconf: the key in question
6283  */
6284 void ieee80211_key_replay(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
6285 
6286 /**
6287  * ieee80211_wake_queue - wake specific queue
6288  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6289  * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
6290  *
6291  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_wake_queue.
6292  */
6293 void ieee80211_wake_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
6294 
6295 /**
6296  * ieee80211_stop_queue - stop specific queue
6297  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6298  * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
6299  *
6300  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_stop_queue.
6301  */
6302 void ieee80211_stop_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
6303 
6304 /**
6305  * ieee80211_queue_stopped - test status of the queue
6306  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6307  * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
6308  *
6309  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_queue_stopped.
6310  *
6311  * Return: %true if the queue is stopped. %false otherwise.
6312  */
6313 
6314 int ieee80211_queue_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
6315 
6316 /**
6317  * ieee80211_stop_queues - stop all queues
6318  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6319  *
6320  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_stop_all_queues.
6321  */
6322 void ieee80211_stop_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6323 
6324 /**
6325  * ieee80211_wake_queues - wake all queues
6326  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6327  *
6328  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_wake_all_queues.
6329  */
6330 void ieee80211_wake_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6331 
6332 /**
6333  * ieee80211_scan_completed - completed hardware scan
6334  *
6335  * When hardware scan offload is used (i.e. the hw_scan() callback is
6336  * assigned) this function needs to be called by the driver to notify
6337  * mac80211 that the scan finished. This function can be called from
6338  * any context, including hardirq context.
6339  *
6340  * @hw: the hardware that finished the scan
6341  * @info: information about the completed scan
6342  */
6343 void ieee80211_scan_completed(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6344 			      struct cfg80211_scan_info *info);
6345 
6346 /**
6347  * ieee80211_sched_scan_results - got results from scheduled scan
6348  *
6349  * When a scheduled scan is running, this function needs to be called by the
6350  * driver whenever there are new scan results available.
6351  *
6352  * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
6353  */
6354 void ieee80211_sched_scan_results(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6355 
6356 /**
6357  * ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped - inform that the scheduled scan has stopped
6358  *
6359  * When a scheduled scan is running, this function can be called by
6360  * the driver if it needs to stop the scan to perform another task.
6361  * Usual scenarios are drivers that cannot continue the scheduled scan
6362  * while associating, for instance.
6363  *
6364  * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
6365  */
6366 void ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6367 
6368 /**
6369  * enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags - interface iteration flags
6370  * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL: Iterate over all interfaces that have
6371  *	been added to the driver; However, note that during hardware
6372  *	reconfiguration (after restart_hw) it will iterate over a new
6373  *	interface and over all the existing interfaces even if they
6374  *	haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
6375  * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL: During resume, iterate over all
6376  *	interfaces, even if they haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
6377  * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE: Iterate only active interfaces (netdev is up).
6378  * @IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER: Skip any interfaces where SDATA
6379  *	is not in the driver.  This may fix crashes during firmware recovery
6380  *	for instance.
6381  */
6382 enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags {
6383 	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL	= 0,
6384 	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL	= BIT(0),
6385 	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE	= BIT(1),
6386 	IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER	= BIT(2),
6387 };
6388 
6389 /**
6390  * ieee80211_iterate_interfaces - iterate interfaces
6391  *
6392  * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6393  * hardware and calls the callback for them. This includes active as well as
6394  * inactive interfaces. This function allows the iterator function to sleep.
6395  * Will iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6396  *
6397  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6398  * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6399  * @iterator: the iterator function to call
6400  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6401  */
6402 void ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
6403 				  void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
6404 						   struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6405 				  void *data);
6406 
6407 /**
6408  * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces - iterate active interfaces
6409  *
6410  * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6411  * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6412  * This function allows the iterator function to sleep, when the iterator
6413  * function is atomic @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic can
6414  * be used.
6415  * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6416  *
6417  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6418  * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6419  * @iterator: the iterator function to call
6420  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6421  */
6422 static inline void
6423 ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
6424 				    void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
6425 						     struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6426 				    void *data)
6427 {
6428 	ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(hw,
6429 				     iter_flags | IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE,
6430 				     iterator, data);
6431 }
6432 
6433 /**
6434  * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic - iterate active interfaces
6435  *
6436  * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6437  * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6438  * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
6439  * if that is not desired, use @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces instead.
6440  * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6441  *
6442  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6443  * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6444  * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6445  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6446  */
6447 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6448 						u32 iter_flags,
6449 						void (*iterator)(void *data,
6450 						    u8 *mac,
6451 						    struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6452 						void *data);
6453 
6454 struct ieee80211_vif *
6455 __ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6456 			       struct ieee80211_vif *prev,
6457 			       u32 iter_flags);
6458 
6459 /**
6460  * for_each_interface - iterate interfaces under wiphy mutex
6461  * @vif: the iterator variable
6462  * @hw: the HW to iterate for
6463  * @flags: the iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6464  */
6465 #define for_each_interface(vif, hw, flags)				\
6466 	for (vif = __ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(hw, NULL, flags);	\
6467 	     vif;							\
6468 	     vif = __ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(hw, vif, flags))
6469 
6470 /**
6471  * for_each_active_interface - iterate active interfaces under wiphy mutex
6472  * @vif: the iterator variable
6473  * @hw: the HW to iterate for
6474  */
6475 #define for_each_active_interface(vif, hw)				\
6476 	for_each_interface(vif, hw, IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE)
6477 
6478 /**
6479  * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx - iterate active interfaces
6480  *
6481  * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6482  * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6483  * This version can only be used while holding the wiphy mutex.
6484  *
6485  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6486  * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6487  * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6488  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6489  */
6490 static inline void
6491 ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6492 					u32 iter_flags,
6493 					void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
6494 							 struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6495 					void *data)
6496 {
6497 	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
6498 
6499 	for_each_interface(vif, hw, iter_flags | IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE)
6500 		iterator(data, vif->addr, vif);
6501 }
6502 
6503 /**
6504  * ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic - iterate stations
6505  *
6506  * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given
6507  * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback
6508  * function for them.
6509  * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
6510  *
6511  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6512  * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6513  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6514  */
6515 void ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6516 				       void (*iterator)(void *data,
6517 						struct ieee80211_sta *sta),
6518 				       void *data);
6519 
6520 struct ieee80211_sta *
6521 __ieee80211_iterate_stations(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6522 			     struct ieee80211_sta *prev);
6523 
6524 /**
6525  * for_each_station - iterate stations under wiphy mutex
6526  * @sta: the iterator variable
6527  * @hw: the HW to iterate for
6528  */
6529 #define for_each_station(sta, hw)					\
6530 	for (sta = __ieee80211_iterate_stations(hw, NULL);		\
6531 	     sta;							\
6532 	     sta = __ieee80211_iterate_stations(hw, sta))
6533 
6534 /**
6535  * ieee80211_iterate_stations_mtx - iterate stations
6536  *
6537  * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given
6538  * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback
6539  * function for them. This version can only be used while holding the wiphy
6540  * mutex.
6541  *
6542  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6543  * @iterator: the iterator function to call
6544  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6545  */
6546 static inline void
6547 ieee80211_iterate_stations_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6548 			       void (*iterator)(void *data,
6549 						struct ieee80211_sta *sta),
6550 			       void *data)
6551 {
6552 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
6553 
6554 	for_each_station(sta, hw)
6555 		iterator(data, sta);
6556 }
6557 
6558 /**
6559  * ieee80211_queue_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
6560  *
6561  * Drivers and mac80211 use this to add work onto the mac80211 workqueue.
6562  * This helper ensures drivers are not queueing work when they should not be.
6563  *
6564  * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
6565  * @work: the work we want to add onto the mac80211 workqueue
6566  */
6567 void ieee80211_queue_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct work_struct *work);
6568 
6569 /**
6570  * ieee80211_queue_delayed_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
6571  *
6572  * Drivers and mac80211 use this to queue delayed work onto the mac80211
6573  * workqueue.
6574  *
6575  * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
6576  * @dwork: delayable work to queue onto the mac80211 workqueue
6577  * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing
6578  */
6579 void ieee80211_queue_delayed_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6580 				  struct delayed_work *dwork,
6581 				  unsigned long delay);
6582 
6583 /**
6584  * ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer - Refresh a tx agg session timer.
6585  * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
6586  * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6587  *
6588  * This function allows low level driver to refresh tx agg session timer
6589  * to maintain BA session, the session level will still be managed by the
6590  * mac80211.
6591  *
6592  * Note: must be called in an RCU critical section.
6593  */
6594 void ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6595 					    u16 tid);
6596 
6597 /**
6598  * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session - Start a tx Block Ack session.
6599  * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
6600  * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6601  * @timeout: session timeout value (in TUs)
6602  *
6603  * Return: success if addBA request was sent, failure otherwise
6604  *
6605  * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
6606  * the need to start aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
6607  * will be managed by the mac80211.
6608  */
6609 int ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid,
6610 				  u16 timeout);
6611 
6612 /**
6613  * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to aggregate.
6614  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6615  * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
6616  * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6617  *
6618  * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
6619  * finished with preparations for the BA session. It can be called
6620  * from any context.
6621  */
6622 void ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
6623 				      u16 tid);
6624 
6625 /**
6626  * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session - Stop a Block Ack session.
6627  * @sta: the station whose BA session to stop
6628  * @tid: the TID to stop BA.
6629  *
6630  * Return: negative error if the TID is invalid, or no aggregation active
6631  *
6632  * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
6633  * the need to stop aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
6634  * will be managed by the mac80211.
6635  */
6636 int ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid);
6637 
6638 /**
6639  * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to stop aggregate.
6640  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6641  * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
6642  * @tid: the desired TID to BA on.
6643  *
6644  * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
6645  * finished with preparations for the BA session tear down. It
6646  * can be called from any context.
6647  */
6648 void ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
6649 				     u16 tid);
6650 
6651 /**
6652  * ieee80211_find_sta - find a station
6653  *
6654  * @vif: virtual interface to look for station on
6655  * @addr: station's address
6656  *
6657  * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
6658  *
6659  * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
6660  * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
6661  */
6662 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6663 					 const u8 *addr);
6664 
6665 /**
6666  * ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr - find a station on hardware
6667  *
6668  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6669  * @addr: remote station's address
6670  * @localaddr: local address (vif->sdata->vif.addr). Use NULL for 'any'.
6671  *
6672  * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
6673  *
6674  * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
6675  * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
6676  *
6677  * NOTE: You may pass NULL for localaddr, but then you will just get
6678  *      the first STA that matches the remote address 'addr'.
6679  *      We can have multiple STA associated with multiple
6680  *      logical stations (e.g. consider a station connecting to another
6681  *      BSSID on the same AP hardware without disconnecting first).
6682  *      In this case, the result of this method with localaddr NULL
6683  *      is not reliable.
6684  *
6685  * DO NOT USE THIS FUNCTION with localaddr NULL if at all possible.
6686  */
6687 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6688 					       const u8 *addr,
6689 					       const u8 *localaddr);
6690 
6691 /**
6692  * ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs - find STA by link addresses
6693  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6694  * @addr: remote station's link address
6695  * @localaddr: local link address, use %NULL for any (but avoid that)
6696  * @link_id: pointer to obtain the link ID if the STA is found,
6697  *	may be %NULL if the link ID is not needed
6698  *
6699  * Obtain the STA by link address, must use RCU protection.
6700  *
6701  * Return: pointer to STA if found, otherwise %NULL.
6702  */
6703 struct ieee80211_sta *
6704 ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6705 				 const u8 *addr,
6706 				 const u8 *localaddr,
6707 				 unsigned int *link_id);
6708 
6709 /**
6710  * ieee80211_sta_block_awake - block station from waking up
6711  * @hw: the hardware
6712  * @pubsta: the station
6713  * @block: whether to block or unblock
6714  *
6715  * Some devices require that all frames that are on the queues
6716  * for a specific station that went to sleep are flushed before
6717  * a poll response or frames after the station woke up can be
6718  * delivered to that it. Note that such frames must be rejected
6719  * by the driver as filtered, with the appropriate status flag.
6720  *
6721  * This function allows implementing this mode in a race-free
6722  * manner.
6723  *
6724  * To do this, a driver must keep track of the number of frames
6725  * still enqueued for a specific station. If this number is not
6726  * zero when the station goes to sleep, the driver must call
6727  * this function to force mac80211 to consider the station to
6728  * be asleep regardless of the station's actual state. Once the
6729  * number of outstanding frames reaches zero, the driver must
6730  * call this function again to unblock the station. That will
6731  * cause mac80211 to be able to send ps-poll responses, and if
6732  * the station queried in the meantime then frames will also
6733  * be sent out as a result of this. Additionally, the driver
6734  * will be notified that the station woke up some time after
6735  * it is unblocked, regardless of whether the station actually
6736  * woke up while blocked or not.
6737  */
6738 void ieee80211_sta_block_awake(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6739 			       struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, bool block);
6740 
6741 /**
6742  * ieee80211_sta_eosp - notify mac80211 about end of SP
6743  * @pubsta: the station
6744  *
6745  * When a device transmits frames in a way that it can't tell
6746  * mac80211 in the TX status about the EOSP, it must clear the
6747  * %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP bit and call this function instead.
6748  * This applies for PS-Poll as well as uAPSD.
6749  *
6750  * Note that just like with _tx_status() and _rx() drivers must
6751  * not mix calls to irqsafe/non-irqsafe versions, this function
6752  * must not be mixed with those either. Use the all irqsafe, or
6753  * all non-irqsafe, don't mix!
6754  *
6755  * NB: the _irqsafe version of this function doesn't exist, no
6756  *     driver needs it right now. Don't call this function if
6757  *     you'd need the _irqsafe version, look at the git history
6758  *     and restore the _irqsafe version!
6759  */
6760 void ieee80211_sta_eosp(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6761 
6762 /**
6763  * ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc - ask mac80211 to send NDP with EOSP
6764  * @pubsta: the station
6765  * @tid: the tid of the NDP
6766  *
6767  * Sometimes the device understands that it needs to close
6768  * the Service Period unexpectedly. This can happen when
6769  * sending frames that are filling holes in the BA window.
6770  * In this case, the device can ask mac80211 to send a
6771  * Nullfunc frame with EOSP set. When that happens, the
6772  * driver must have called ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() to
6773  * let mac80211 know that there are no buffered frames any
6774  * more, otherwise mac80211 will get the more_data bit wrong.
6775  * The low level driver must have made sure that the frame
6776  * will be sent despite the station being in power-save.
6777  * Mac80211 won't call allow_buffered_frames().
6778  * Note that calling this function, doesn't exempt the driver
6779  * from closing the EOSP properly, it will still have to call
6780  * ieee80211_sta_eosp when the NDP is sent.
6781  */
6782 void ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, int tid);
6783 
6784 /**
6785  * ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates - recalculate aggregate data after a change
6786  * @pubsta: the station
6787  *
6788  * Call this function after changing a per-link aggregate data as referenced in
6789  * &struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates by accessing the agg field of
6790  * &struct ieee80211_link_sta.
6791  *
6792  * With non MLO the data in deflink will be referenced directly. In that case
6793  * there is no need to call this function.
6794  */
6795 void ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6796 
6797 /**
6798  * ieee80211_sta_register_airtime - register airtime usage for a sta/tid
6799  *
6800  * Register airtime usage for a given sta on a given tid. The driver must call
6801  * this function to notify mac80211 that a station used a certain amount of
6802  * airtime. This information will be used by the TXQ scheduler to schedule
6803  * stations in a way that ensures airtime fairness.
6804  *
6805  * The reported airtime should as a minimum include all time that is spent
6806  * transmitting to the remote station, including overhead and padding, but not
6807  * including time spent waiting for a TXOP. If the time is not reported by the
6808  * hardware it can in some cases be calculated from the rate and known frame
6809  * composition. When possible, the time should include any failed transmission
6810  * attempts.
6811  *
6812  * The driver can either call this function synchronously for every packet or
6813  * aggregate, or asynchronously as airtime usage information becomes available.
6814  * TX and RX airtime can be reported together, or separately by setting one of
6815  * them to 0.
6816  *
6817  * @pubsta: the station
6818  * @tid: the TID to register airtime for
6819  * @tx_airtime: airtime used during TX (in usec)
6820  * @rx_airtime: airtime used during RX (in usec)
6821  */
6822 void ieee80211_sta_register_airtime(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
6823 				    u32 tx_airtime, u32 rx_airtime);
6824 
6825 /**
6826  * ieee80211_txq_airtime_check - check if a txq can send frame to device
6827  *
6828  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6829  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
6830  *
6831  * Return: %true if the AQL's airtime limit has not been reached and the txq can
6832  * continue to send more packets to the device. Otherwise return %false.
6833  */
6834 bool
6835 ieee80211_txq_airtime_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
6836 
6837 /**
6838  * ieee80211_iter_keys - iterate keys programmed into the device
6839  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6840  * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6841  * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6842  * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6843  *
6844  * Context: Must be called with wiphy mutex held; can sleep.
6845  *
6846  * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6847  * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6848  * the device. This is intended for use in WoWLAN if the device
6849  * needs reprogramming of the keys during suspend.
6850  *
6851  * The order in which the keys are iterated matches the order
6852  * in which they were originally installed and handed to the
6853  * set_key callback.
6854  */
6855 void ieee80211_iter_keys(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6856 			 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6857 			 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6858 				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6859 				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6860 				      struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6861 				      void *data),
6862 			 void *iter_data);
6863 
6864 /**
6865  * ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu - iterate keys programmed into the device
6866  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6867  * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6868  * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6869  * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6870  *
6871  * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6872  * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6873  * the device. Note that due to locking reasons, keys of station
6874  * in removal process will be skipped.
6875  *
6876  * This function requires being called in an RCU critical section,
6877  * and thus iter must be atomic.
6878  */
6879 void ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6880 			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6881 			     void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6882 					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6883 					  struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6884 					  struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6885 					  void *data),
6886 			     void *iter_data);
6887 
6888 /**
6889  * ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic - iterate channel contexts
6890  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6891  * @iter: iterator function
6892  * @iter_data: data passed to iterator function
6893  *
6894  * Iterate all active channel contexts. This function is atomic and
6895  * doesn't acquire any locks internally that might be held in other
6896  * places while calling into the driver.
6897  *
6898  * The iterator will not find a context that's being added (during
6899  * the driver callback to add it) but will find it while it's being
6900  * removed.
6901  *
6902  * Note that during hardware restart, all contexts that existed
6903  * before the restart are considered already present so will be
6904  * found while iterating, whether they've been re-added already
6905  * or not.
6906  */
6907 void ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic(
6908 	struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6909 	void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6910 		     struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf,
6911 		     void *data),
6912 	void *iter_data);
6913 
6914 /**
6915  * ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_mtx - iterate channel contexts
6916  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6917  * @iter: iterator function
6918  * @iter_data: data passed to iterator function
6919  *
6920  * Iterate all active channel contexts. This function can only be used while
6921  * holding the wiphy mutex.
6922  *
6923  * The iterator will not find a context that's being added (during
6924  * the driver callback to add it) but will find it while it's being
6925  * removed.
6926  *
6927  * Note that during hardware restart, all contexts that existed
6928  * before the restart are considered already present so will be
6929  * found while iterating, whether they've been re-added already
6930  * or not.
6931  */
6932 void ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_mtx(
6933 	struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6934 	void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6935 		     struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf,
6936 		     void *data),
6937 	void *iter_data);
6938 
6939 /**
6940  * ieee80211_ap_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
6941  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6942  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6943  *
6944  * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
6945  * hardware. The template is filled with bssid, ssid and supported rate
6946  * information. This function must only be called from within the
6947  * .bss_info_changed callback function and only in managed mode. The function
6948  * is only useful when the interface is associated, otherwise it will return
6949  * %NULL.
6950  *
6951  * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
6952  */
6953 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_ap_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6954 					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6955 
6956 /**
6957  * ieee80211_beacon_loss - inform hardware does not receive beacons
6958  *
6959  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6960  *
6961  * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER and
6962  * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set, the driver needs to inform whenever the
6963  * hardware is not receiving beacons with this function.
6964  */
6965 void ieee80211_beacon_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6966 
6967 /**
6968  * ieee80211_connection_loss - inform hardware has lost connection to the AP
6969  *
6970  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6971  *
6972  * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER, and
6973  * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS and %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR are set, the driver
6974  * needs to inform if the connection to the AP has been lost.
6975  * The function may also be called if the connection needs to be terminated
6976  * for some other reason, even if %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR isn't set.
6977  *
6978  * This function will cause immediate change to disassociated state,
6979  * without connection recovery attempts.
6980  */
6981 void ieee80211_connection_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6982 
6983 /**
6984  * ieee80211_disconnect - request disconnection
6985  *
6986  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6987  * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired
6988  *
6989  * Request disconnection from the current network and, if enabled, send a
6990  * hint to the higher layers that immediate reconnect is desired.
6991  */
6992 void ieee80211_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool reconnect);
6993 
6994 /**
6995  * ieee80211_resume_disconnect - disconnect from AP after resume
6996  *
6997  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6998  *
6999  * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after resume.
7000  * Drivers can use this after WoWLAN if they know that the
7001  * connection cannot be kept up, for example because keys were
7002  * used while the device was asleep but the replay counters or
7003  * similar cannot be retrieved from the device during resume.
7004  *
7005  * Note that due to implementation issues, if the driver uses
7006  * the reconfiguration functionality during resume the interface
7007  * will still be added as associated first during resume and then
7008  * disconnect normally later.
7009  *
7010  * This function can only be called from the resume callback and
7011  * the driver must not be holding any of its own locks while it
7012  * calls this function, or at least not any locks it needs in the
7013  * key configuration paths (if it supports HW crypto).
7014  */
7015 void ieee80211_resume_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7016 
7017 /**
7018  * ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect - disconnect from AP after
7019  * hardware restart
7020  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7021  *
7022  * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after
7023  * hardware restart.
7024  */
7025 void ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7026 
7027 /**
7028  * ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify - inform a configured connection quality monitoring
7029  *	rssi threshold triggered
7030  *
7031  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7032  * @rssi_event: the RSSI trigger event type
7033  * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available
7034  * @gfp: context flags
7035  *
7036  * When the %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI is set, and a connection quality
7037  * monitoring is configured with an rssi threshold, the driver will inform
7038  * whenever the rssi level reaches the threshold.
7039  */
7040 void ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7041 			       enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
7042 			       s32 rssi_level,
7043 			       gfp_t gfp);
7044 
7045 /**
7046  * ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - inform CQM of beacon loss
7047  *
7048  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7049  * @gfp: context flags
7050  */
7051 void ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, gfp_t gfp);
7052 
7053 /**
7054  * ieee80211_radar_detected - inform that a radar was detected
7055  *
7056  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7057  * @chanctx_conf: Channel context on which radar is detected. Mandatory to
7058  *	pass a valid pointer during MLO. For non-MLO %NULL can be passed
7059  */
7060 void ieee80211_radar_detected(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7061 			      struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf);
7062 
7063 /**
7064  * ieee80211_chswitch_done - Complete channel switch process
7065  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7066  * @success: make the channel switch successful or not
7067  * @link_id: the link_id on which the switch was done. Ignored if success is
7068  *	false.
7069  *
7070  * Complete the channel switch post-process: set the new operational channel
7071  * and wake up the suspended queues.
7072  */
7073 void ieee80211_chswitch_done(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool success,
7074 			     unsigned int link_id);
7075 
7076 /**
7077  * ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect - disconnect due to channel switch error
7078  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7079  *
7080  * Instruct mac80211 to disconnect due to a channel switch error. The channel
7081  * switch can request to block the tx and so, we need to make sure we do not send
7082  * a deauth frame in this case.
7083  */
7084 void ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7085 
7086 /**
7087  * ieee80211_request_smps - request SM PS transition
7088  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7089  * @link_id: link ID for MLO, or 0
7090  * @smps_mode: new SM PS mode
7091  *
7092  * This allows the driver to request an SM PS transition in managed
7093  * mode. This is useful when the driver has more information than
7094  * the stack about possible interference, for example by bluetooth.
7095  */
7096 void ieee80211_request_smps(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
7097 			    enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode);
7098 
7099 /**
7100  * ieee80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain-on-channel start
7101  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7102  */
7103 void ieee80211_ready_on_channel(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
7104 
7105 /**
7106  * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
7107  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7108  */
7109 void ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
7110 
7111 /**
7112  * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session - callback to stop existing BA sessions
7113  *
7114  * in order not to harm the system performance and user experience, the device
7115  * may request not to allow any rx ba session and tear down existing rx ba
7116  * sessions based on system constraints such as periodic BT activity that needs
7117  * to limit wlan activity (eg.sco or a2dp)."
7118  * in such cases, the intention is to limit the duration of the rx ppdu and
7119  * therefore prevent the peer device to use a-mpdu aggregation.
7120  *
7121  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7122  * @ba_rx_bitmap: Bit map of open rx ba per tid
7123  * @addr: & to bssid mac address
7124  */
7125 void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 ba_rx_bitmap,
7126 				  const u8 *addr);
7127 
7128 /**
7129  * ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames - move RX BA window and mark filtered
7130  * @pubsta: station struct
7131  * @tid: the session's TID
7132  * @ssn: starting sequence number of the bitmap, all frames before this are
7133  *	assumed to be out of the window after the call
7134  * @filtered: bitmap of filtered frames, BIT(0) is the @ssn entry etc.
7135  * @received_mpdus: number of received mpdus in firmware
7136  *
7137  * This function moves the BA window and releases all frames before @ssn, and
7138  * marks frames marked in the bitmap as having been filtered. Afterwards, it
7139  * checks if any frames in the window starting from @ssn can now be released
7140  * (in case they were only waiting for frames that were filtered.)
7141  * (Only work correctly if @max_rx_aggregation_subframes <= 64 frames)
7142  */
7143 void ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
7144 					  u16 ssn, u64 filtered,
7145 					  u16 received_mpdus);
7146 
7147 /**
7148  * ieee80211_send_bar - send a BlockAckReq frame
7149  *
7150  * can be used to flush pending frames from the peer's aggregation reorder
7151  * buffer.
7152  *
7153  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7154  * @ra: the peer's destination address
7155  * @tid: the TID of the aggregation session
7156  * @ssn: the new starting sequence number for the receiver
7157  */
7158 void ieee80211_send_bar(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 *ra, u16 tid, u16 ssn);
7159 
7160 /**
7161  * ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl - helper to queue an RX BA work
7162  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
7163  * @addr: station mac address
7164  * @tid: the rx tid
7165  */
7166 void ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *addr,
7167 				 unsigned int tid);
7168 
7169 /**
7170  * ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl - start a Rx BA session
7171  *
7172  * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
7173  * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
7174  * reordering.
7175  *
7176  * Create structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
7177  * when they complete AddBa negotiation.
7178  *
7179  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
7180  * @addr: station mac address
7181  * @tid: the rx tid
7182  */
7183 static inline void ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7184 						      const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
7185 {
7186 	if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
7187 		return;
7188 	ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid);
7189 }
7190 
7191 /**
7192  * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl - stop a Rx BA session
7193  *
7194  * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
7195  * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
7196  * reordering.
7197  *
7198  * Destroy structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
7199  * when they complete DelBa negotiation.
7200  *
7201  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
7202  * @addr: station mac address
7203  * @tid: the rx tid
7204  */
7205 static inline void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7206 						     const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
7207 {
7208 	if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
7209 		return;
7210 	ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid + IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS);
7211 }
7212 
7213 /**
7214  * ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired - stop a Rx BA session due to timeout
7215  *
7216  * Some device drivers do not offload AddBa/DelBa negotiation, but handle rx
7217  * buffer reording internally, and therefore also handle the session timer.
7218  *
7219  * Trigger the timeout flow, which sends a DelBa.
7220  *
7221  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
7222  * @addr: station mac address
7223  * @tid: the rx tid
7224  */
7225 void ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7226 				   const u8 *addr, unsigned int tid);
7227 
7228 /* Rate control API */
7229 
7230 /**
7231  * struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control - rate control information for/from RC algo
7232  *
7233  * @hw: The hardware the algorithm is invoked for.
7234  * @sband: The band this frame is being transmitted on.
7235  * @bss_conf: the current BSS configuration
7236  * @skb: the skb that will be transmitted, the control information in it needs
7237  *	to be filled in
7238  * @reported_rate: The rate control algorithm can fill this in to indicate
7239  *	which rate should be reported to userspace as the current rate and
7240  *	used for rate calculations in the mesh network.
7241  * @rts: whether RTS will be used for this frame because it is longer than the
7242  *	RTS threshold
7243  * @short_preamble: whether mac80211 will request short-preamble transmission
7244  *	if the selected rate supports it
7245  * @rate_idx_mask: user-requested (legacy) rate mask
7246  * @rate_idx_mcs_mask: user-requested MCS rate mask (NULL if not in use)
7247  * @bss: whether this frame is sent out in AP or IBSS mode
7248  */
7249 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control {
7250 	struct ieee80211_hw *hw;
7251 	struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband;
7252 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf *bss_conf;
7253 	struct sk_buff *skb;
7254 	struct ieee80211_tx_rate reported_rate;
7255 	bool rts, short_preamble;
7256 	u32 rate_idx_mask;
7257 	u8 *rate_idx_mcs_mask;
7258 	bool bss;
7259 };
7260 
7261 /**
7262  * enum rate_control_capabilities - rate control capabilities
7263  */
7264 enum rate_control_capabilities {
7265 	/**
7266 	 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW:
7267 	 * Support for extended NSS BW support (dot11VHTExtendedNSSCapable)
7268 	 * Note that this is only looked at if the minimum number of chains
7269 	 * that the AP uses is < the number of TX chains the hardware has,
7270 	 * otherwise the NSS difference doesn't bother us.
7271 	 */
7272 	RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW = BIT(0),
7273 	/**
7274 	 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER:
7275 	 * mac80211 should start A-MPDU sessions on tx
7276 	 */
7277 	RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER = BIT(1),
7278 };
7279 
7280 struct rate_control_ops {
7281 	unsigned long capa;
7282 	const char *name;
7283 	void *(*alloc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
7284 	void (*add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, void *priv,
7285 			    struct dentry *debugfsdir);
7286 	void (*free)(void *priv);
7287 
7288 	void *(*alloc_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, gfp_t gfp);
7289 	void (*rate_init)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7290 			  struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7291 			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta);
7292 	void (*rate_update)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7293 			    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
7294 			    struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
7295 			    u32 changed);
7296 	void (*free_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
7297 			 void *priv_sta);
7298 
7299 	void (*tx_status_ext)(void *priv,
7300 			      struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7301 			      void *priv_sta, struct ieee80211_tx_status *st);
7302 	void (*tx_status)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7303 			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
7304 			  struct sk_buff *skb);
7305 	void (*get_rate)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
7306 			 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control *txrc);
7307 
7308 	void (*add_sta_debugfs)(void *priv, void *priv_sta,
7309 				struct dentry *dir);
7310 
7311 	u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(void *priv_sta);
7312 };
7313 
7314 static inline int rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
7315 				 enum nl80211_band band,
7316 				 int index)
7317 {
7318 	return (sta == NULL || sta->deflink.supp_rates[band] & BIT(index));
7319 }
7320 
7321 static inline s8
7322 rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7323 		  struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
7324 {
7325 	int i;
7326 
7327 	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
7328 		if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
7329 			return i;
7330 
7331 	/* warn when we cannot find a rate. */
7332 	WARN_ON_ONCE(1);
7333 
7334 	/* and return 0 (the lowest index) */
7335 	return 0;
7336 }
7337 
7338 static inline
7339 bool rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7340 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
7341 {
7342 	unsigned int i;
7343 
7344 	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
7345 		if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
7346 			return true;
7347 	return false;
7348 }
7349 
7350 /**
7351  * rate_control_set_rates - pass the sta rate selection to mac80211/driver
7352  *
7353  * When not doing a rate control probe to test rates, rate control should pass
7354  * its rate selection to mac80211. If the driver supports receiving a station
7355  * rate table, it will use it to ensure that frames are always sent based on
7356  * the most recent rate control module decision.
7357  *
7358  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7359  * @pubsta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer to the target destination.
7360  * @rates: new tx rate set to be used for this station.
7361  *
7362  * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
7363  */
7364 int rate_control_set_rates(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7365 			   struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
7366 			   struct ieee80211_sta_rates *rates);
7367 
7368 int ieee80211_rate_control_register(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
7369 void ieee80211_rate_control_unregister(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
7370 
7371 static inline bool
7372 conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7373 {
7374 	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20;
7375 }
7376 
7377 static inline bool
7378 conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7379 {
7380 	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
7381 	       conf->chandef.center_freq1 < conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
7382 }
7383 
7384 static inline bool
7385 conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7386 {
7387 	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
7388 	       conf->chandef.center_freq1 > conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
7389 }
7390 
7391 static inline bool
7392 conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7393 {
7394 	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40;
7395 }
7396 
7397 static inline bool
7398 conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
7399 {
7400 	return (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5) &&
7401 		(conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10) &&
7402 		(conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT);
7403 }
7404 
7405 static inline enum nl80211_iftype
7406 ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type, bool p2p)
7407 {
7408 	if (p2p) {
7409 		switch (type) {
7410 		case NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION:
7411 			return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT;
7412 		case NL80211_IFTYPE_AP:
7413 			return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO;
7414 		default:
7415 			break;
7416 		}
7417 	}
7418 	return type;
7419 }
7420 
7421 static inline enum nl80211_iftype
7422 ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7423 {
7424 	return ieee80211_iftype_p2p(vif->type, vif->p2p);
7425 }
7426 
7427 /**
7428  * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif - return HE capabilities for sband/vif
7429  * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
7430  * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
7431  *
7432  * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or %NULL is none found
7433  */
7434 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap *
7435 ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7436 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7437 {
7438 	return ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
7439 }
7440 
7441 /**
7442  * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif - return HE 6 GHz capabilities
7443  * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
7444  * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
7445  *
7446  * Return: the 6GHz capabilities
7447  */
7448 static inline __le16
7449 ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7450 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7451 {
7452 	return ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
7453 }
7454 
7455 /**
7456  * ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif - return EHT capabilities for sband/vif
7457  * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
7458  * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
7459  *
7460  * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap, or %NULL is none found
7461  */
7462 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap *
7463 ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7464 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7465 {
7466 	return ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
7467 }
7468 
7469 /**
7470  * ieee80211_get_uhr_iftype_cap_vif - return UHR capabilities for sband/vif
7471  * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
7472  * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
7473  *
7474  * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_uhr_cap, or %NULL is none found
7475  */
7476 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_uhr_cap *
7477 ieee80211_get_uhr_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7478 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7479 {
7480 	return ieee80211_get_uhr_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
7481 }
7482 
7483 /**
7484  * ieee80211_update_mu_groups - set the VHT MU-MIMO groud data
7485  *
7486  * @vif: the specified virtual interface
7487  * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, otherwise 0
7488  * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
7489  * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
7490  *
7491  * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid and the position and
7492  * membership data is of the correct size and are in the same byte order as the
7493  * matching GroupId management frame.
7494  * Calls to this function need to be serialized with RX path.
7495  */
7496 void ieee80211_update_mu_groups(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
7497 				const u8 *membership, const u8 *position);
7498 
7499 void ieee80211_enable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7500 				   int rssi_min_thold,
7501 				   int rssi_max_thold);
7502 
7503 void ieee80211_disable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7504 
7505 /**
7506  * ieee80211_ave_rssi - report the average RSSI for the specified interface
7507  *
7508  * @vif: the specified virtual interface
7509  * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, or -1 for non-MLO
7510  *
7511  * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid.
7512  *
7513  * Return: The average RSSI value for the requested interface, or 0 if not
7514  * applicable.
7515  */
7516 int ieee80211_ave_rssi(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int link_id);
7517 
7518 /**
7519  * ieee80211_calculate_rx_timestamp - calculate timestamp in frame
7520  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7521  * @status: RX status
7522  * @mpdu_len: total MPDU length (including FCS)
7523  * @mpdu_offset: offset into MPDU to calculate timestamp at
7524  *
7525  * This function calculates the RX timestamp at the given MPDU offset, taking
7526  * into account what the RX timestamp was. An offset of 0 will just normalize
7527  * the timestamp to TSF at beginning of MPDU reception.
7528  *
7529  * Returns: the calculated timestamp
7530  */
7531 u64 ieee80211_calculate_rx_timestamp(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7532 				     struct ieee80211_rx_status *status,
7533 				     unsigned int mpdu_len,
7534 				     unsigned int mpdu_offset);
7535 
7536 /**
7537  * ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report WoWLAN wakeup
7538  * @vif: virtual interface
7539  * @wakeup: wakeup reason(s)
7540  * @gfp: allocation flags
7541  *
7542  * See cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup().
7543  */
7544 void ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7545 				    struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup,
7546 				    gfp_t gfp);
7547 
7548 /**
7549  * ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb - prepare an 802.11 skb for transmission
7550  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7551  * @vif: virtual interface
7552  * @skb: frame to be sent from within the driver
7553  * @band: the band to transmit on
7554  * @sta: optional pointer to get the station to send the frame to
7555  *
7556  * Return: %true if the skb was prepared, %false otherwise.
7557  * On failure, the skb is freed by this function; callers must not
7558  * free it again.
7559  *
7560  * Note: must be called under RCU lock
7561  */
7562 bool ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7563 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct sk_buff *skb,
7564 			      int band, struct ieee80211_sta **sta);
7565 
7566 /**
7567  * ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap - Sanity-check and parse the radiotap header
7568  *				 of injected frames.
7569  *
7570  * To accurately parse and take into account rate and retransmission fields,
7571  * you must initialize the chandef field in the ieee80211_tx_info structure
7572  * of the skb before calling this function.
7573  *
7574  * @skb: packet injected by userspace
7575  * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
7576  *
7577  * Return: %true if the radiotap header was parsed, %false otherwise
7578  */
7579 bool ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap(struct sk_buff *skb,
7580 				 struct net_device *dev);
7581 
7582 /**
7583  * struct ieee80211_noa_data - holds temporary data for tracking P2P NoA state
7584  *
7585  * @next_tsf: TSF timestamp of the next absent state change
7586  * @has_next_tsf: next absent state change event pending
7587  *
7588  * @absent: descriptor bitmask, set if GO is currently absent
7589  *
7590  * private:
7591  *
7592  * @count: count fields from the NoA descriptors
7593  * @desc: adjusted data from the NoA
7594  */
7595 struct ieee80211_noa_data {
7596 	u32 next_tsf;
7597 	bool has_next_tsf;
7598 
7599 	u8 absent;
7600 
7601 	u8 count[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
7602 	struct {
7603 		u32 start;
7604 		u32 duration;
7605 		u32 interval;
7606 	} desc[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
7607 };
7608 
7609 /**
7610  * ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa - initialize NoA tracking data from P2P IE
7611  *
7612  * @attr: P2P NoA IE
7613  * @data: NoA tracking data
7614  * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
7615  *
7616  * Return: number of successfully parsed descriptors
7617  */
7618 int ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa(const struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr *attr,
7619 			    struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
7620 
7621 /**
7622  * ieee80211_update_p2p_noa - get next pending P2P GO absent state change
7623  *
7624  * @data: NoA tracking data
7625  * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
7626  */
7627 void ieee80211_update_p2p_noa(struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
7628 
7629 /**
7630  * ieee80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform a TDLS operation
7631  * @vif: virtual interface
7632  * @peer: the peer's destination address
7633  * @oper: the requested TDLS operation
7634  * @reason_code: reason code for the operation, valid for TDLS teardown
7635  * @gfp: allocation flags
7636  *
7637  * See cfg80211_tdls_oper_request().
7638  */
7639 void ieee80211_tdls_oper_request(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *peer,
7640 				 enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper,
7641 				 u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp);
7642 
7643 /**
7644  * ieee80211_reserve_tid - request to reserve a specific TID
7645  *
7646  * There is sometimes a need (such as in TDLS) for blocking the driver from
7647  * using a specific TID so that the FW can use it for certain operations such
7648  * as sending PTI requests. To make sure that the driver doesn't use that TID,
7649  * this function must be called as it flushes out packets on this TID and marks
7650  * it as blocked, so that any transmit for the station on this TID will be
7651  * redirected to the alternative TID in the same AC.
7652  *
7653  * Note that this function blocks and may call back into the driver, so it
7654  * should be called without driver locks held. Also note this function should
7655  * only be called from the driver's @sta_state callback.
7656  *
7657  * @sta: the station to reserve the TID for
7658  * @tid: the TID to reserve
7659  *
7660  * Returns: 0 on success, else on failure
7661  */
7662 int ieee80211_reserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
7663 
7664 /**
7665  * ieee80211_unreserve_tid - request to unreserve a specific TID
7666  *
7667  * Once there is no longer any need for reserving a certain TID, this function
7668  * should be called, and no longer will packets have their TID modified for
7669  * preventing use of this TID in the driver.
7670  *
7671  * Note that this function blocks and acquires a lock, so it should be called
7672  * without driver locks held. Also note this function should only be called
7673  * from the driver's @sta_state callback.
7674  *
7675  * @sta: the station
7676  * @tid: the TID to unreserve
7677  */
7678 void ieee80211_unreserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
7679 
7680 /**
7681  * ieee80211_tx_dequeue - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
7682  *
7683  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7684  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
7685  *	ieee80211_next_txq()
7686  *
7687  * Return: the skb if successful, %NULL if no frame was available.
7688  *
7689  * Note that this must be called in an rcu_read_lock() critical section,
7690  * which can only be released after the SKB was handled. Some pointers in
7691  * skb->cb, e.g. the key pointer, are protected by RCU and thus the
7692  * critical section must persist not just for the duration of this call
7693  * but for the duration of the frame handling.
7694  * However, also note that while in the wake_tx_queue() method,
7695  * rcu_read_lock() is already held.
7696  *
7697  * softirqs must also be disabled when this function is called.
7698  * In process context, use ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni() instead.
7699  */
7700 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7701 				     struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7702 
7703 /**
7704  * ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
7705  * (in process context)
7706  *
7707  * Like ieee80211_tx_dequeue() but can be called in process context
7708  * (internally disables bottom halves).
7709  *
7710  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7711  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
7712  *	ieee80211_next_txq()
7713  *
7714  * Return: the skb if successful, %NULL if no frame was available.
7715  */
7716 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7717 						      struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
7718 {
7719 	struct sk_buff *skb;
7720 
7721 	local_bh_disable();
7722 	skb = ieee80211_tx_dequeue(hw, txq);
7723 	local_bh_enable();
7724 
7725 	return skb;
7726 }
7727 
7728 /**
7729  * ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue - mac80211 handler for wake_tx_queue callback
7730  *
7731  * @hw: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
7732  * @txq: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
7733  *
7734  * Drivers can use this function for the mandatory mac80211 wake_tx_queue
7735  * callback in struct ieee80211_ops. They should not call this function.
7736  */
7737 void ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7738 				    struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7739 
7740 /**
7741  * ieee80211_next_txq - get next tx queue to pull packets from
7742  *
7743  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7744  * @ac: AC number to return packets from.
7745  *
7746  * Return: the next txq if successful, %NULL if no queue is eligible. If a txq
7747  * is returned, it should be returned with ieee80211_return_txq() after the
7748  * driver has finished scheduling it.
7749  */
7750 struct ieee80211_txq *ieee80211_next_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
7751 
7752 /**
7753  * ieee80211_txq_schedule_start - start new scheduling round for TXQs
7754  *
7755  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7756  * @ac: AC number to acquire locks for
7757  *
7758  * Should be called before ieee80211_next_txq() or ieee80211_return_txq().
7759  * The driver must not call multiple TXQ scheduling rounds concurrently.
7760  */
7761 void ieee80211_txq_schedule_start(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
7762 
7763 /* (deprecated) */
7764 static inline void ieee80211_txq_schedule_end(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac)
7765 {
7766 }
7767 
7768 void __ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7769 			      struct ieee80211_txq *txq, bool force);
7770 
7771 /**
7772  * ieee80211_schedule_txq - schedule a TXQ for transmission
7773  *
7774  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7775  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7776  *
7777  * Schedules a TXQ for transmission if it is not already scheduled,
7778  * even if mac80211 does not have any packets buffered.
7779  *
7780  * The driver may call this function if it has buffered packets for
7781  * this TXQ internally.
7782  */
7783 static inline void
7784 ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
7785 {
7786 	__ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, true);
7787 }
7788 
7789 /**
7790  * ieee80211_return_txq - return a TXQ previously acquired by ieee80211_next_txq()
7791  *
7792  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7793  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7794  * @force: schedule txq even if mac80211 does not have any buffered packets.
7795  *
7796  * The driver may set force=true if it has buffered packets for this TXQ
7797  * internally.
7798  */
7799 static inline void
7800 ieee80211_return_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
7801 		     bool force)
7802 {
7803 	__ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, force);
7804 }
7805 
7806 /**
7807  * ieee80211_txq_may_transmit - check whether TXQ is allowed to transmit
7808  *
7809  * This function is used to check whether given txq is allowed to transmit by
7810  * the airtime scheduler, and can be used by drivers to access the airtime
7811  * fairness accounting without using the scheduling order enforced by
7812  * next_txq().
7813  *
7814  * Returns %true if the airtime scheduler thinks the TXQ should be allowed to
7815  * transmit, and %false if it should be throttled. This function can also have
7816  * the side effect of rotating the TXQ in the scheduler rotation, which will
7817  * eventually bring the deficit to positive and allow the station to transmit
7818  * again.
7819  *
7820  * The API ieee80211_txq_may_transmit() also ensures that TXQ list will be
7821  * aligned against driver's own round-robin scheduler list. i.e it rotates
7822  * the TXQ list till it makes the requested node becomes the first entry
7823  * in TXQ list. Thus both the TXQ list and driver's list are in sync. If this
7824  * function returns %true, the driver is expected to schedule packets
7825  * for transmission, and then return the TXQ through ieee80211_return_txq().
7826  *
7827  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7828  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7829  *
7830  * Return: %true if transmission is allowed, %false otherwise
7831  */
7832 bool ieee80211_txq_may_transmit(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7833 				struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7834 
7835 /**
7836  * ieee80211_txq_get_depth - get pending frame/byte count of given txq
7837  *
7838  * The values are not guaranteed to be coherent with regard to each other, i.e.
7839  * txq state can change half-way of this function and the caller may end up
7840  * with "new" frame_cnt and "old" byte_cnt or vice-versa.
7841  *
7842  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7843  * @frame_cnt: pointer to store frame count
7844  * @byte_cnt: pointer to store byte count
7845  */
7846 void ieee80211_txq_get_depth(struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
7847 			     unsigned long *frame_cnt,
7848 			     unsigned long *byte_cnt);
7849 
7850 /**
7851  * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination.
7852  *
7853  * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function termination.
7854  * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7855  *
7856  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7857  * @inst_id: the local instance id
7858  * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*)
7859  * @gfp: allocation flags
7860  */
7861 void ieee80211_nan_func_terminated(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7862 				   u8 inst_id,
7863 				   enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason,
7864 				   gfp_t gfp);
7865 
7866 /**
7867  * ieee80211_nan_func_match - notify about NAN function match event.
7868  *
7869  * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function match. The
7870  * cookie inside the match struct will be assigned by mac80211.
7871  * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7872  *
7873  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7874  * @match: match event information
7875  * @gfp: allocation flags
7876  */
7877 void ieee80211_nan_func_match(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7878 			      struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match,
7879 			      gfp_t gfp);
7880 
7881 /**
7882  * ieee80211_nan_sched_update_done - notify that NAN schedule update is done
7883  *
7884  * This function is called by the driver to notify mac80211 that the NAN
7885  * schedule update has been applied.
7886  * Must be called with wiphy mutex held. May sleep.
7887  *
7888  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7889  */
7890 void ieee80211_nan_sched_update_done(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7891 
7892 /**
7893  * ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for RX.
7894  *
7895  * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7896  * rate information in the RX status struct and the frame length.
7897  *
7898  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7899  * @status: &struct ieee80211_rx_status containing the transmission rate
7900  *          information.
7901  * @len: frame length in bytes
7902  *
7903  * Return: the airtime estimate
7904  */
7905 u32 ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7906 			      struct ieee80211_rx_status *status,
7907 			      int len);
7908 
7909 /**
7910  * ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for TX.
7911  *
7912  * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7913  * rate information in the TX info struct and the frame length.
7914  *
7915  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7916  * @info: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
7917  * @len: frame length in bytes
7918  *
7919  * Return: the airtime estimate
7920  */
7921 u32 ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7922 			      struct ieee80211_tx_info *info,
7923 			      int len);
7924 /**
7925  * ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl - Get FILS discovery template.
7926  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7927  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7928  * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO.
7929  *
7930  * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7931  *
7932  * Return: FILS discovery template. %NULL on error.
7933  */
7934 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7935 						  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7936 						  unsigned int link_id);
7937 
7938 /**
7939  * ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl - Get unsolicited broadcast
7940  *	probe response template.
7941  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7942  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7943  * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO.
7944  *
7945  * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7946  *
7947  * Return: Unsolicited broadcast probe response template. %NULL on error.
7948  */
7949 struct sk_buff *
7950 ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7951 					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7952 					  unsigned int link_id);
7953 
7954 /**
7955  * ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify - notify userland about a BSS color
7956  * collision.
7957  * @link_id: valid link_id during MLO or 0 for non-MLO
7958  *
7959  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7960  * @color_bitmap: a 64 bit bitmap representing the colors that the local BSS is
7961  *	aware of.
7962  */
7963 void
7964 ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7965 				      u64 color_bitmap, u8 link_id);
7966 
7967 /**
7968  * ieee80211_is_tx_data - check if frame is a data frame
7969  *
7970  * The function is used to check if a frame is a data frame. Frames with
7971  * hardware encapsulation enabled are data frames.
7972  *
7973  * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
7974  *
7975  * Return: %true if @skb is a data frame, %false otherwise
7976  */
7977 static inline bool ieee80211_is_tx_data(struct sk_buff *skb)
7978 {
7979 	struct ieee80211_tx_info *info = IEEE80211_SKB_CB(skb);
7980 	struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (void *) skb->data;
7981 
7982 	return info->flags & IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP ||
7983 	       ieee80211_is_data(hdr->frame_control);
7984 }
7985 
7986 /**
7987  * ieee80211_set_active_links - set active links in client mode
7988  * @vif: interface to set active links on
7989  * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
7990  *
7991  * Context: Must be called with wiphy mutex held; may sleep; calls
7992  *	back into the driver.
7993  *
7994  * This changes the active links on an interface. The interface
7995  * must be in client mode (in AP mode, all links are always active),
7996  * and @active_links must be a subset of the vif's valid_links.
7997  *
7998  * If a link is switched off and another is switched on at the same
7999  * time (e.g. active_links going from 0x1 to 0x10) then you will get
8000  * a sequence of calls like
8001  *
8002  *  - change_vif_links(0x11)
8003  *  - unassign_vif_chanctx(link_id=0)
8004  *  - assign_vif_chanctx(link_id=4)
8005  *  - change_sta_links(0x11) for each affected STA (the AP)
8006  *    (TDLS connections on now inactive links should be torn down)
8007  *  - remove group keys on the old link (link_id 0)
8008  *  - add new group keys (GTK/IGTK/BIGTK) on the new link (link_id 4)
8009  *  - change_sta_links(0x10) for each affected STA (the AP)
8010  *  - change_vif_links(0x10)
8011  *
8012  * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
8013  */
8014 int ieee80211_set_active_links(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 active_links);
8015 
8016 /**
8017  * ieee80211_set_active_links_async - asynchronously set active links
8018  * @vif: interface to set active links on
8019  * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
8020  *
8021  * See ieee80211_set_active_links() for more information, the only
8022  * difference here is that the link change is triggered async and
8023  * can be called in any context, but the link switch will only be
8024  * completed after it returns.
8025  */
8026 void ieee80211_set_active_links_async(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
8027 				      u16 active_links);
8028 
8029 /**
8030  * ieee80211_send_teardown_neg_ttlm - tear down a negotiated TTLM request
8031  * @vif: the interface on which the tear down request should be sent.
8032  *
8033  * This function can be used to tear down a previously accepted negotiated
8034  * TTLM request.
8035  */
8036 void ieee80211_send_teardown_neg_ttlm(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
8037 
8038 /**
8039  * ieee80211_chan_width_to_rx_bw - convert channel width to STA RX bandwidth
8040  * @width: the channel width value to convert
8041  * Return: the STA RX bandwidth value for the channel width
8042  */
8043 static inline enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth
8044 ieee80211_chan_width_to_rx_bw(enum nl80211_chan_width width)
8045 {
8046 	switch (width) {
8047 	default:
8048 		WARN_ON_ONCE(1);
8049 		fallthrough;
8050 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT:
8051 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20:
8052 		return IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20;
8053 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40:
8054 		return IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40;
8055 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80:
8056 		return IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80;
8057 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_160:
8058 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_80P80:
8059 		return IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160;
8060 	case NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_320:
8061 		return IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320;
8062 	}
8063 }
8064 
8065 /**
8066  * ieee80211_prepare_rx_omi_bw - prepare for sending BW RX OMI
8067  * @link_sta: the link STA the OMI is going to be sent to
8068  * @bw: the bandwidth requested
8069  *
8070  * When the driver decides to do RX OMI to change bandwidth with a STA
8071  * it calls this function to prepare, then sends the OMI, and finally
8072  * calls ieee80211_finalize_rx_omi_bw().
8073  *
8074  * Note that the (link) STA rate control is updated accordingly as well,
8075  * but the chanctx might not be updated if there are other users.
8076  * If the intention is to reduce the listen bandwidth, the driver must
8077  * ensure there are no TDLS stations nor other uses of the chanctx.
8078  *
8079  * Also note that in order to sequence correctly, narrowing bandwidth
8080  * will only happen in ieee80211_finalize_rx_omi_bw(), whereas widening
8081  * again (e.g. going back to normal) will happen here.
8082  *
8083  * Note that we treat this symmetrically, so if the driver calls this
8084  * and tells the peer to only send with a lower bandwidth, we assume
8085  * that the driver also wants to only send at that lower bandwidth, to
8086  * allow narrowing of the chanctx request for this station/interface.
8087  *
8088  * Finally, the driver must ensure that if the function returned %true,
8089  * ieee80211_finalize_rx_omi_bw() is also called, even for example in
8090  * case of HW restart.
8091  *
8092  * Context: Must be called with wiphy mutex held, and will call back
8093  *	    into the driver, so ensure no driver locks are held.
8094  *
8095  * Return: %true if changes are going to be made, %false otherwise
8096  */
8097 bool ieee80211_prepare_rx_omi_bw(struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta,
8098 				 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth bw);
8099 
8100 /**
8101  * ieee80211_finalize_rx_omi_bw - finalize BW RX OMI update
8102  * @link_sta: the link STA the OMI was sent to
8103  *
8104  * See ieee80211_client_prepare_rx_omi_bw(). Context is the same here
8105  * as well.
8106  */
8107 void ieee80211_finalize_rx_omi_bw(struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta);
8108 
8109 /* for older drivers - let's not document these ... */
8110 int ieee80211_emulate_add_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
8111 				  struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
8112 void ieee80211_emulate_remove_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
8113 				      struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
8114 void ieee80211_emulate_change_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
8115 				      struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx,
8116 				      u32 changed);
8117 int ieee80211_emulate_switch_vif_chanctx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
8118 					 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs,
8119 					 int n_vifs,
8120 					 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode);
8121 
8122 /**
8123  * ieee80211_vif_nan_started - Return whether a NAN vif is started
8124  * @vif: the vif
8125  * Return: %true iff the vif is a NAN interface and NAN is started
8126  */
8127 bool ieee80211_vif_nan_started(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
8128 
8129 /**
8130  * ieee80211_encrypt_tx_skb - Encrypt the transmit skb
8131  * @skb: the skb
8132  * Return: 0 if success and non-zero on error
8133  */
8134 int ieee80211_encrypt_tx_skb(struct sk_buff *skb);
8135 #endif /* MAC80211_H */
8136